2015 4C
2015
OWNER’S MANUAL
Chrysler Group LLC
154C-126-AB
Second Edition
Printed in U.S.A.
4C
VEHICLES SOLD IN CANADA
With respect to any Vehicles Sold in Canada, the name
Chrysler Group LLC shall be deemed to be deleted and the
name Chrysler Canada Inc. used in substitution therefore.
DRIVING AND ALCOHOL
Drunken driving is one of the most frequent causes of
accidents.
Your driving ability can be seriously impaired with blood
alcohol levels far below the legal minimum. If you are
drinking, don’t drive. Ride with a designated nondrinking driver, call a cab, a friend, or use public transportation.
This manual illustrates and describes the operation of
features and equipment that are either standard or optional on this vehicle. This manual may also include a
description of features and equipment that are no longer
available or were not ordered on this vehicle. Please
disregard any features and equipment described in this
manual that are not on this vehicle.
Chrysler Group LLC reserves the right to make changes
in design and specifications, and/or make additions to or
improvements to its products without imposing any
obligation upon itself to install them on products previously manufactured.
WARNING!
Driving after drinking can lead to an accident.
Your perceptions are less sharp, your reflexes are
slower, and your judgment is impaired when you
have been drinking. Never drink and then drive.
Copyright © 2014 Chrysler Group LLC
SECTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
PAGE
1
1
INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
2
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2
3
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
3
4
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
4
5
STARTING AND OPERATING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
5
6
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
6
7
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
7
8
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
8
9
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
9
10
INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
10
INTRODUCTION
CONTENTS
䡵 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 䡵 VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER . . . . . . . .7
䡵 HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 䡵 VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS . . . .8
䡵 WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
1
4 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION
The enclosed Warranty Information lists the services that
FIAT Group Automobiles offers to its customers:
Congratulations on selecting your new vehicle. Be assured that it represents precision workmanship, distinc- • The Warranty Certificate with terms and conditions for
tive styling, and high quality - all essentials that are
maintaining its validity
traditional to our vehicles.
• The range of additional services available to FIAT
This Owner’s Manual has been prepared with the assisGroup Automobiles customers
tance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint
NOTE: After reviewing the owner information, it
you with the operation and maintenance of your vehicle.
should be stored in the vehicle for convenient referencIt is supplemented by Warranty Information, and various
ing and remain with the vehicle when sold.
customer-oriented documents. Please take the time to
read these publications carefully. Following the instruc- When it comes to service, remember that your authorized
tions and recommendations in this manual will help dealer knows your vehicle best, has factory-trained techassure safe and enjoyable operation of your vehicle.
nicians and genuine parts, and cares about your satisfaction.
INTRODUCTION 5
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
Consult the Table of Contents to determine which section
contains the information you desire.
Since the specification of your vehicle depends on the
items of equipment ordered, certain descriptions and
illustrations may differ from your vehicle’s equipment.
The detailed index at the back of this Owner’s Manual
contains a complete listing of all subjects.
Consult the following table for a description of the
symbols that may be used on your vehicle or throughout
this Owner’s Manual:
1
6 INTRODUCTION
INTRODUCTION 7
WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS
This Owners Manual contains WARNINGS against operating procedures that could result in a collision or
bodily injury. It also contains CAUTIONS against procedures that could result in damage to your vehicle. If you
do not read this entire Owners Manual, you may miss
important information. Observe all Warnings and Cautions.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is found on the
left front corner of the instrument panel, visible through
Vehicle Identification Number
the windshield. This number also appears engraved on
an Aluminum plate glued and riveted on the floor NOTE: It is illegal to remove or alter the VIN.
crossmember under the passenger seat.
1
8 INTRODUCTION
VEHICLE MODIFICATIONS/ALTERATIONS
WARNING!
Any modifications or alterations to this vehicle could
seriously affect its roadworthiness and safety and
may lead to a collision resulting in serious injury or
death.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2
CONTENTS
䡵 A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
▫ To Disarm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .16
▫ Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 䡵 ILLUMINATED ENTRY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
▫ Locking Doors With A Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13 䡵 REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) —
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Key-In-Ignition Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
▫ To Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 SENTRY KEY® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
▫ To Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
▫ Transmitter Battery Replacement . .
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . .
䡵 VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM SYSTEM — IF
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15 䡵 DOOR LOCKS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ To Arm The System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
. . . . . . . . .17
. . . . . . . . .18
. . . . . . . . .18
. . . . . . . . .19
. . . . . . . . .21
. . . . . . . . .21
▫ Central Door Locking/Unlocking . . . . . . . . . . .21
10 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Locking/Unlocking Doors From The Inside . . .23
▫ Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
▫ Emergency Door Locking Device . . . . . . . . . . .23 䡵 ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS . . . .65
▫ Door Opening/Closing Mechanism Reset . . . . .24 䡵 SAFETY TIPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
䡵 WINDOWS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
▫ Transporting Passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
▫ Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
▫ Exhaust Gas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
䡵 DECKLID . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27
▫ Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
䡵 OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS . . . . . . . . . .30
▫ Seat Belt Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
▫ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . .41
▫ Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 11
A WORD ABOUT YOUR KEYS
Ignition Key Removal
The key fob contains the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) 1. Push the brake pedal and place the transmission into
transmitter with an integrated key. To use the mechanical
first (1) or reverse (R) gear by selecting/pushing the
key simply push the mechanical key release button.
buttons on the console.
Key Fob
1 — Vehicle Key
2 — Push To Open/Close Vehicle Key
Transmission Gear Selector
2. Rotate the key to the STOP (OFF/LOCK) position and
engage the handbrake and release brake pedal.
2
12 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
3. Remove the key from the ignition switch lock cylinder.
Ignition Switch Positions
1 — STOP (OFF/LOCK)
2 — MAR (ACC/ON/RUN)
3 — AVV (START)
WARNING!
• Before exiting the vehicle, always apply the parking brake, and remove the Key Fob from the
ignition. When leaving the vehicle, always lock
your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 13
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
Key-In-Ignition Reminder
Opening the driver’s door when the key is in the ignition
and the ignition switch position is OFF/LOCK, sounds a
signal to remove the key.
SENTRY KEY®
CAUTION!
An unlocked car is an invitation to thieves. Always
remove the key from the ignition and lock all the
doors when leaving the vehicle unattended.
Locking Doors With A Key
You can insert the key with either side up. To lock the
door, turn the key to the left. To unlock the door, turn the
key to the right. Refer to “Body Lubrication” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for maintenance information.
The Sentry Key® Immobilizer System prevents unauthorized vehicle operation by disabling the engine. The
system does not need to be armed or activated. Operation
is automatic, regardless of whether the vehicle is locked
or unlocked.
The system uses ignition keys which have an embedded
electronic chip (transponder) to prevent unauthorized
vehicle operation. Therefore, only keys that are programmed to the vehicle can be used to start and operate
the vehicle.
2
14 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: A key which has not been programmed is also Replacement Keys
considered an invalid key, even if it is cut to fit the
NOTE: Only keys that have been programmed to the
ignition switch lock cylinder for that vehicle.
vehicle electronics can be used to start the vehicle. Once
If the Vehicle Security Light is on after the key is turned a Sentry Key® has been programmed to a vehicle, it
to the ON/RUN position, it indicates that there is a cannot be programmed to any other vehicle.
problem with the electronics.
NOTE: When having the Sentry Key® Immobilizer
System serviced, bring all vehicle keys with you to an
CAUTION!
authorized dealer.
• Always remove the Sentry Key® from the vehicle General Information
and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle unatThe Sentry Key® system complies with FCC rules part 15
tended.
• The Sentry Key® Immobilizer system is not com- and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is
patible with some aftermarket remote starting sys- subject to the following conditions:
tems. Use of these systems may result in vehicle • This device may not cause harmful interference.
starting problems and loss of security protection.
• This device must accept any interference that may be
received, including interference that may cause undeAll of the keys provided with your new vehicle have
sired operation.
been programmed to the vehicle electronics.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 15
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved 4. Anomalous lifting/tilting of the vehicle.
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
Operation of the alarm is indicated by a visual signal
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
(flashing of the direction indicators for several seconds).
There is a maximum number of visual cycles. When this
VEHICLE SECURITY ALARM SYSTEM — IF
is reached the system returns to normal operation.
EQUIPPED
The Vehicle Security Alarm monitors the doors and
decklid for unauthorized entry. It will also activate the
siren and emit a visual flash of the turn signals (front and
rear) for any of the following intrusion cases.
Operation
The alarm activates in the following cases:
To Arm The System
With the doors and decklid closed and the ignition key
either turned to STOP (OFF/LOCK) or removed, point
the key towards the vehicle then push and release the
lock button.
The system emits a visual signal and activates door
locking.
1. Wrongful opening of one of the doors or the decklid
A self-diagnosis stage lasting approximately 30 seconds
(perimeter protection);
precedes the activation of the alarm. During the self2. Cutting of the battery leads;
diagnosis, the vehicle security light flashes in the instrument panel at a frequency of about one flash per second.
3. Movement inside the passenger compartment (volumetric protection);
2
16 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
After the self-diagnosis stage, the vehicle security light The following operations are performed:
flashes at a lower frequency (approximately one flash
• Two brief flashes of the direction indicators.
every three seconds).
• Unlocking of the doors.
If, after the alarm is switched on, a second visual signal
emit via the vehicle security light in the instrument panel, NOTE:
wait about four seconds and switch off the alarm by
• If the central door locking system is released using the
pushing the lock button, check that the doors and decklid
metal insert of the key, the alarm is not disabled.
are closed correctly and then reactivate the system by
pushing the unlock button.
• In the event of accidental activation of the alarm, or in
any case to interrupt the visual signal cycle when
If the alarm emits a visual signal even when the doors
activated, it is possible to push the unlock button or
and decklid are closed correctly, a system malfunction
turn the ignition key to MAR (ON/RUN) for at least
has occurred: in this case, contact a authorized vehicle
five seconds, after which the system will deactivate.
Dealership.
To Disarm The System
Deactivation
Push the unlock button.
Disarming
To completely disable the alarm (e.g. during a lengthy
period of vehicle inactivity), lock the vehicle by turning
the metal insert of the key in the door lock.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 17
NOTE: If the batteries of the key fob run out or there is a
fault in the system, the alarm can be switched off by
inserting the key in the ignition switch and turning it to
MAR (ON/RUN).
ILLUMINATED ENTRY
NOTE: None of the courtesy lights will operate if the
dimmer control is in the “defeat” position (extreme
downward position), unless the overhead map/reading
lights are turned on manually.
REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (RKE) — IF
The interior lights will turn on whenever a door is EQUIPPED
opened and the dimmer switch is not in the defeat This system allows you to lock or unlock the doors and
decklid from distances up to approximately 66 ft (20 m)
position.
using a hand-held Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitThe interior lights will turn on, remain on for approxiter. The RKE transmitter does not need to be pointed at
mately 30 seconds, and then fade to off if a door is
the vehicle to activate the system.
opened using the outside door handle and then closed or
a door is unlocked using the vehicles key.
The interior lights will turn on and remain on for about
four seconds and then fade to off if a door is opened
using the inside door handle.
2
18 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
To Unlock The Doors
Push and release the UNLOCK button on the RKE
transmitter to unlock the doors. The park lights and turn
signal lights will flash to acknowledge the signal and the
illuminated entry system will turn on.
NOTE: The Door Unlock Indicator will illuminate in the
instrument panel when one or both doors are unlocked.
To Lock The Doors
Key Fob
Push and release the LOCK button on the RKE transmitter: locking of doors, switching off of internal roof light
and single flashing of direction indicators.
If one or more door are open, the doors will not be
locked. This is indicated by a rapid flashing of the
direction indicators. The doors will be locked if the
NOTE: The line of transmission must not be blocked decklid is open however.
with metal objects.
When a speed of more than 12 mph (20 km/h) is reached,
the doors will be locked automatically if the Autoclose
1 — Vehicle Key
2 — Push To Open/Close Vehicle Key
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 19
function was selected. Refer to “Electronic Vehicle Infor- Transmitter Battery Replacement
mation Center (EVIC)” in “Understanding Your InstruNOTE: Perchlorate Material – special handling may
ment Panel” for further information.
apply.
See
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
When the doors are locked from outside the car (using perchlorate
the remote control), the door lock indicator will illumiThe recommended replacement battery is CR2032.
nate for a few seconds and then start flashing (deterrent
function).
Door LED Lock Indicator
Battery Replacement Procedure
2
20 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Replace the Key Fob battery with the following proce- 3. Remove battery compartment #4;
dure:
4. Replace battery #5, respecting the polarity;
1. Push button #1 and move the metal insert #2 to
5. Reinsert compartment #4 in the key and secure it by
opening position;
turning screw #3 to lock.
2. Turn screw #3 to unlock using a fine bit screwdriver;
Key Fob Screw Location
Key Fob Screw Location
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 21
2. Closeness to a radio transmitter such as a radio station
tower, airport transmitter, and some mobile or CB
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
radios.
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
DOOR LOCKS
General Information
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
Central Door Locking/Unlocking
• This device must accept any interference received, Locking Doors From The Outside
including interference that may cause undesired opWith the doors closed, push the lock button on the key
eration.
fob or turn the metal insert (located inside the key fob) in
NOTE: Changes or modifications not expressly approved the door lock.
by the party responsible for compliance could void the
will illuminate
The Door Lock LED Indicator button
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
to indicate that the doors have locked.
If your RKE transmitter fails to operate from a normal
distance, check for these two conditions:
1. A weak battery in the transmitter. The expected life of
the battery is a minimum of three years.
2
22 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
Door Lock LED Indicator
NOTE: Door locking is carried out with all doors shut.
Unlocking Doors From The Outside
Push the unlock button on the key or turn the metal
insert (located inside the key) in the driver side door lock.
• For personal security and safety in the event of a
collision, lock the vehicle doors before you drive as
well as when you park and leave the vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle, or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 23
Locking/Unlocking Doors From The Inside
Emergency Door Locking Device
Push the Lock LED Indicator button
. The button has
an LED that indicates whether the doors are locked or
unlocked.
Passenger Side Door
The passenger side door has a device to lock it when
there is no current.
Pushing the Lock LED Indicator button
again cenTo lock it, place the metal insert of the ignition key in
trally unlocks all doors and switches off the LED.
housing #1 and turn it clockwise.
Pushing the Lock LED Indicator button
again centrally locks all the doors. The doors will be locked only
if all the doors are properly shut.
Once the doors have been locked using the remote
control or the key, it will no longer be possible to unlock
.
them by pushing the Lock LED Indicator button
NOTE: In the absence of electrical power supply (blown
fuse, battery disconnected, etc.) it is still possible to lock
the doors manually.
2
24 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Introduce the metal insert of the ignition key in the
front door pawl; or
• Pull the internal door handle.
Door Opening/Closing Mechanism Reset
If the battery is disconnected or the protection fuse
blows, the door opening/closing mechanism must be
reset as follows:
1. Close all the doors.
Emergency Door Lock Function
2. Push the unlock button on the key or the door
on the
locking/unlocking LED indicator button
dashboard.
To restore the starting condition of the door locks (only if
3. Push the lock button on the key or the door locking/
battery charge restored), proceed as follows:
unlocking LED indicator button
on the dash• Push the Unlock button on the remote control;
board.
• Push the door locking/unlocking LED indicator buton the dashboard; or
ton
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 25
WINDOWS
Power Windows
2
NOTE:
• These operate when the ignition key is turned to
MAR-ON and for about three minutes after the ignition key is turned to STOP or removed unless one of
the doors is opened.
• The buttons are located on the center console.
Power Window Switch
1 — Driver Power Window Switch
2 — Passenger Power Window Switch
Push the corresponding buttons to open/close the desired window.
26 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
When one of the two buttons is pushed briefly, the Electric Window System Reset
window moves in stages; if the button is held down to
After a break in power supply for the control units
open, ⬙continuous automatic⬙ operation is activated.
(battery replaced or disconnected or protective fuses for
If the button is pushed again the window will stop in its the electric window control units replaced), the autocurrent position. If the button is pushed for several matic operation of the windows must be restored.
seconds, the window lowers automatically (only with
The restoration procedure must be performed as deignition key in MAR-ON position).
scribed below with the doors closed:
Continuous Automatic Operation
1. Completely open the driver’s door window keeping
This is activated by pushing one of the two buttons for
the operating button pushed for at least three seconds
longer than half a second. The window will stop when it
after the (lower) end of travel position is reached.
is fully opened, or when the button is pushed again.
2. Completely raise the driver side window and hold the
It can be used on both the driver side and passenger side,
only for lowering the window.
button down for at least three seconds once the
(upper) end of travel position has been reached.
3. Proceed in the same way as described in points 1 and
2 for the passenger side door.
4. Make sure that the reset is correct by checking that the
windows work automatically.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 27
WARNING!
Improper actuation of the power windows may be
dangerous. Never leave children unattended in a
vehicle, and do not let children play with power
windows. Before and during window operation
make sure no one and no object (including clothing)
is in the path of the moving glass or its mechanism.
Do not leave the key fob in or near the vehicle, or in
a location accessible to children. Occupants, particularly unattended children, can become entrapped by
the windows while operating the power window
switches. Such entrapment may result in serious
injury or death.
DECKLID
NOTE: During normal car operation, the luggage compartment can reach temperatures above 149º F (65° C).
Pay attention when transporting objects that may be
damaged at such temperatures. Do not keep aerosol cans
in the car: danger of explosion. Aerosol cans must not be
exposed to temperatures above 122º F (50° C).
Opening Procedure
With driver side door open, pull lever #1 located at the
point illustrated in the figure.
2
28 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Insert the end of the rod in housing, making sure that the
rod engages in the smallest hole of the retaining clip.
Care must be taken to keep the decklid raised until the
rod is fixed in the correct position.
NOTE: Maintain a tight grip on the decklid when raising,
in order to prevent any external occurrence (e.g. a gust of
wind) from suddenly opening the decklid to end of
travel. Additionally, in order to prevent any damage to
the car or broken windows, do not force the decklid
beyond the opening position necessary to secure the
supporting rod in the hole of the retaining clip.
Decklid Release Lever Location
1 — Decklid Release Lever
Raise the decklid and release supporting rod from its
locking device.
Closing Procedure
1. Hold the decklid up with one hand and use the other
to remove rod from housing and reinsert it in its
locking device.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 29
2. Lower the decklid approximately 7.8 inches (20 cm)
from the engine compartment and let it drop. Make
sure that the decklid is completely closed and not only
fastened in safety position by trying to open it. If it is
not completely closed, do not push the decklid down,
but raise it and repeat the procedure.
NOTE: Always check that the decklid is closed correctly
to prevent it from opening while the car is travelling.
WARNING!
• The maximum permitted load in the luggage compartment, in addition to the kits provided, is
33.1 lbs. (15 kg). Do not exceed the maximum
permitted load in the luggage compartment.
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• When accessing the rear luggage compartment, do
not come into contact with engine, or other components, that may be hot and could burn you if
touched.
• Access the luggage compartment only with the
vehicle stationary. Before exiting a vehicle, you
should always shift the vehicle into gear, remove
the key fob from the ignition, and apply the
parking brake to secure the vehicle against unwanted movement.
• The decklid may drop suddenly, causing serious
injury, if the supporting rod is not positioned
correctly.
• The decklid must always be closed properly, and
the lock engaged, while the car is in motion.
2
30 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2. If a child from 2 to 12 years old (not in a rear-facing
child restraint) must ride in the front passenger seat,
Some of the most important safety features in your
move the seat as far back as possible and use the
vehicle are the restraint systems:
proper child restraint. (Refer to “Child Restraints”).
• Seat Belt Systems
3. Children that are not big enough to wear the vehicle
• Supplemental Restraint Systems (SRS) Air Bags
seat belt properly (Refer to ⬙Child Restraints⬙) should
be secured in a vehicle with a rear seat in child
• Child Restraints
restraints or belt-positioning booster seats. Older chilImportant Safety Precautions:
dren who do not use child restraints or beltpositioning booster seats should ride properly buckled
Please pay close attention to the information in this
up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
section. It tells you how to use your restraint system
properly, to keep you and your passenger as safe as 4. Never allow children to slide the shoulder belt behind
possible.
them or under their arm.
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT SYSTEMS
Here are some simple steps you can take to minimize the 5. You should read the instructions provided with your
risk of harm from a deploying air bag:
child restraint to make sure that you are using it
properly.
1. Children 12 years old and under should always ride
buckled up in a vehicle with a rear seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 31
6. All occupants should always wear their lap and
shoulder belts properly.
7. The driver and front passenger seats should be moved
back as far as practical to allow the Advanced Front
Air Bags room to inflate.
8. Do not lean against the door or window. If your
vehicle has side air bags, and deployment occurs, the
side air bags will inflate forcefully into the space
between you and the door and you could be injured.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Seat Belt Systems
9. If the air bag system in this vehicle needs to be
modified to accommodate a disabled person, contact Buckle up even though you are an excellent driver, even
the Customer Center. Phone numbers are provided on short trips. Someone on the road may be a poor driver
and could cause a collision that includes you. This can
under ⬙If You Need Assistance.⬙
happen far away from home or on your own street.
Research has shown that seat belts save lives, and they
can reduce the seriousness of injuries in a collision. Some
of the worst injuries happen when people are thrown
from the vehicle. Seat belts reduce the possibility of
2
32 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
ejection and the risk of injury caused by striking the buckled. After the sequence completes, the Seat Belt
inside of the vehicle. Everyone in a motor vehicle should Reminder Light remains illuminated until the driver’s seat belt is buckled. The driver should instruct all
be belted at all times.
other occupants to buckle their seat belts.
Enhanced Seat Belt Use Reminder System
(BeltAlert)
It is recommended that pets be restrained in the rear seat
The Belt Alert feature is active whenever the ignition (if equipped) in pet harnesses or pet carriers that are
switch is in the START or ON/RUN position. In this secured by seat belts, and cargo is properly stowed.
condition if the driver is unbelted, a continuous chime BeltAlert can be activated or deactivated by your authosignal will start for few seconds and the Seat Belt rized dealer. Chrysler Group LLC does not recommend
Reminder Light will turn on until the driver seat belt deactivating BeltAlert.
is buckled.
NOTE: If BeltAlert has been deactivated, the Seat Belt
If the driver seat belt is unbuckled once the vehicle speed Reminder Light will continue to illuminate while the
is over 12.5 mph (20 km/h) or when travelling at a speed driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled and a continuous
from 6 to 12.5 mph (10 to 20 km/h) for few seconds, the chime will sound when the ignition switch is first
BeltAlert® warning sequence begins by blinking the Seat placed in the START or ON/RUN position.
and sounding an intermittent
Belt Reminder Light
chime. Once the sequence starts, it will continue for
the entire duration or until the driver’s seat belt is
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 33
Lap/Shoulder Belts
All seating positions in your vehicle are equipped with
lap/shoulder belts.
The seat belt webbing retractor will lock only during very
sudden stops or collisions. This feature allows the shoulder part of the seat belt to move freely with you under
normal conditions. However, in a collision the seat belt
will lock and reduce your risk of striking the inside of the
vehicle or being thrown out of the vehicle.
This seat belt system has a retractor assembly that is
designed to release webbing in a controlled manner. This
feature is designed to help reduce the seat belt force
acting on the occupant’s chest.
WARNING!
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, the air bags won’t deploy at all.
Always wear your seat belt even though you have
air bags.
• In a collision, you and your passengers can suffer
much greater injuries if you are not properly buckled up. You can strike the interior of your vehicle or
other passengers, or you can be thrown out of the
vehicle. Always be sure you and others in your
vehicle are buckled up properly.
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured
or killed.
(Continued)
2
34 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
• Wearing your seat belt incorrectly could make your
injuries in a collision much worse. You might
suffer internal injuries, or you could even slide out
of the seat belt. Follow these instructions to wear
your seat belt safely and to keep your passengers
safe, too.
• Two people should never be belted into a single
seat belt. People belted together can crash into one
another in a collision, hurting one another badly.
Never use a lap/shoulder belt or a lap belt for more
than one person, no matter what their size.
• A lap belt worn too high can increase the risk of
injury in a collision. The seat belt forces won’t be at
the strong hip and pelvic bones, but across your
abdomen. Always wear the lap part of your seat
belt as low as possible and keep it snug.
• A twisted seat belt may not protect you properly. In
a collision, it could even cut into you. Be sure the
seat belt is flat against your body, without twists. If
you can’t straighten a seat belt in your vehicle, take
it to your authorized dealer immediately and have
it fixed.
• A seat belt that is buckled into the wrong buckle
will not protect you properly. The lap portion could
ride too high on your body, possibly causing internal injuries. Always buckle your seat belt into the
buckle nearest you.
(Continued)
(Continued)
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 35
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• A seat belt that is too loose will not protect you
properly. In a sudden stop, you could move too far
forward, increasing the possibility of injury. Wear
your seat belt snugly.
• A seat belt that is worn under your arm is dangerous.
Your body could strike the inside surfaces of the
vehicle in a collision, increasing head and neck
injury. A seat belt worn under the arm can cause
internal injuries. Ribs aren’t as strong as shoulder
bones. Wear the seat belt over your shoulder so that
your strongest bones will take the force in a collision.
• A shoulder belt placed behind you will not protect
you from injury during a collision. You are more
likely to hit your head in a collision if you do not
wear your shoulder belt. The lap and shoulder belt
are meant to be used together.
• A frayed or torn seat belt could rip apart in a
collision and leave you with no protection. Inspect
the seat belt system periodically, checking for cuts,
frays, or loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do not disassemble or modify
the seat belt system. Seat belt assemblies must be
replaced after a collision.
(Continued)
Lap/Shoulder Belt Operating Instructions
1. Enter the vehicle and close the door. Sit back and
adjust the seat.
2
36 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2. The seat belt latch plate is above the back of the front 3. When the seat belt is long enough to fit, insert the latch
seat, and next to your arm in the rear seat (for vehicles
plate into the buckle until you hear a “click.”
equipped with a rear seat). Grasp the latch plate and
pull out the seat belt. Slide the latch plate up the
webbing as far as necessary to allow the seat belt to go
around your lap.
Inserting Latch Plate Into Buckle
Pulling Out The Latch Plate
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 37
4. Position the lap seat belt so that it is snug and lies low 5. Position the shoulder belt across the shoulder and
across your hips, below your abdomen. To remove
chest with minimal, if any slack so that it is comfortslack in the lap belt portion, pull up on the shoulder
able and not resting on your neck. The retractor will
belt. To loosen the lap belt if it is too tight, tilt the latch
withdraw any slack in the shoulder belt.
plate and pull on the lap belt. A snug seat belt reduces
6. To release the seat belt, push the red button on the
the risk of sliding under the seat belt in a collision.
buckle. The seat belt will automatically retract to its
stowed position. If necessary, slide the latch plate
down the webbing to allow the seat belt to retract
fully.
Lap/Shoulder Belt Untwisting Procedure
Use the following procedure to untwist a twisted lap/
shoulder belt.
1. Position the latch plate as close as possible to the
anchor point.
Positioning The Lap Belt
2
38 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
2. At about 6 to 12 in (15 to 30 cm) above the latch plate, across the abdomen. That way the strong bones of the
grasp and twist the seat belt webbing 180 degrees to hips will take the force if there is a collision.
create a fold that begins immediately above the latch
Seat Belt Pretensioner
plate.
The front seat belt system is equipped with pretensioning
3. Slide the latch plate upward over the folded webbing. devices that are designed to remove slack from the seat
The folded webbing must enter the slot at the top of belt in the event of a collision. These devices may
the latch plate.
improve the performance of the seat belt by removing
4. Continue to slide the latch plate up until it clears the slack from the seat belt early in a collision. Pretensioners
folded webbing and the seat belt is no longer twisted. work for all size occupants, including those in child
restraints.
Seat Belts And Pregnant Women
NOTE: These devices are not a substitute for proper seat
We recommend that pregnant women use the seat belts
belt placement by the occupant. The seat belt still must be
throughout their pregnancy. Keeping the mother safe is
worn snugly and positioned properly.
the best way to keep the baby safe.
The pretensioners are triggered by the Occupant RePregnant women should wear the lap portion of the seat
straint Controller (ORC). Like the air bags, the pretenbelt across the thighs and as snug across the hips as
sioners are single use items. A deployed pretensioner or
possible. Keep the seat belt low so that it does not come
a deployed air bag must be replaced immediately.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 39
Energy Management Feature
This vehicle has a seat belt system with an Energy
Management feature in the front seating positions that
may help further reduce the risk of injury in the event of
a collision. This seat belt system has a retractor assembly
that is designed to release webbing in a controlled
manner.
Automatic Locking Retractor Mode (ALR)
The seat belt in the passenger seating position is
equipped with a switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
(ALR) which is used to secure a child restraint system.
For additional information, refer to “Child Restraints” in
“Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle.” The • ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
image below defines the type of feature for each seating •
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
position.
2
40 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
If the passenger seating position is equipped with an with this feature. Children 12 years old and under should
always be properly restrained in a vehicle with a rear
ALR and is being used for normal usage:
seat.
Only pull the seat belt webbing out far enough to
comfortably wrap around the occupant’s mid-section so
WARNING!
as to not activate the ALR. If the ALR is activated, you
will hear a clicking sound as the seat belt retracts.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Allow the webbing to retract completely in this case and
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
then carefully pull out only the amount of webbing
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearnecessary to comfortably wrap around the occupant’s
facing child restraint.
mid-section. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you
•
Only use rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
hear a ⬙click.⬙
with a rear seat.
In Automatic Locking Mode, the shoulder belt is automatically prelocked. The seat belt will still retract to How To Engage The Automatic Locking Mode
remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The Automatic
Locking Mode is available on all passenger-seating posi- 1. Buckle the combination lap and shoulder belt.
tions with a combination lap/shoulder belt.
2. Grasp the shoulder portion and pull downward until
the entire seat belt is extracted.
Use the Automatic Locking Mode anytime a child restraint is installed in a seating position that has a seat belt
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 41
3. Allow the seat belt to retract. As the seat belt retracts,
you will hear a clicking sound. This indicates the seat
belt is now in the Automatic Locking Mode.
How To Disengage The Automatic Locking Mode
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it
to retract completely to disengage the Automatic Locking
Mode and activate the vehicle sensitive (emergency)
locking mode.
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• Failure to replace the seat belt assembly could
increase the risk of injury in collisions.
• Do not use the Automatic Locking Mode to restrain
occupants who are wearing the seat belt or children
who are using booster seats. The locked mode is
only used to install rear-facing or forward-facing
child restraints that have a harness for restraining
the child.
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)
• The seat belt assembly must be replaced if the
switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) feature or any other seat belt function is not working
properly when checked according to the procedures in the Service Manual.
(Continued)
Air Bag System Components
Your vehicle may be equipped with the following air bag
system components:
• Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC)
• Air Bag Warning Light
2
42 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Steering Wheel and Column
• Instrument Panel
instrument panel. The words AIRBAG are embossed on
the air bag covers.
• Knee Impact Bolsters
• Advanced Front Air Bags
• Supplemental Side Air Bags
• Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
• Front and Side Impact Sensors
• Front Seat Belt Pretensioners, Seat Belt Buckle Switch,
and Seat Track Position Sensors
Advanced Front Air Bags
Advanced Front Air Bag Locations
This vehicle has Advanced Front Air Bags for both the
driver and front passenger as a supplement to the seat 1 — Driver And Passenger Advanced Front Air Bags
belt restraint systems. The driver’s Advanced Front Air 2 — Passenger Knee Bolsters
3 — Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag/Driver Knee Bolster
Bag is mounted in the center of the steering wheel. The
passenger’s Advanced Front Air Bag is mounted in the
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 43
WARNING!
• Being too close to the steering wheel or instrument
panel during Advanced Front Air Bag deployment
could cause serious injury, including death. Air
bags need room to inflate. Sit back, comfortably
extending your arms to reach the steering wheel or
instrument panel.
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use a rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
output appropriate to the severity and type of collision as
determined by the Occupant Restraint Controller (ORC),
which may receive information from the front impact
sensors or other system components.
The first stage inflator is triggered immediately during an
impact that requires air bag deployment. A low energy
output is used in less severe collisions. A higher energy
output is used for more severe collisions.
This vehicle may be equipped with driver and/or front
passenger seat track position sensors that may adjust the
inflation rate of the Advanced Front Air Bags based upon
seat position.
This vehicle may be equipped with a driver and/or front
passenger seat belt buckle switch that detects whether
the driver or front passenger seat belt is fastened. The
Advanced Front Air Bag Features
seat belt buckle switch may adjust the inflation rate of the
The Advanced Front Air Bag system has multistage Advanced Front Air Bags.
driver and front passenger air bags. This system provides
2
44 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
WARNING! (Continued)
• No objects should be placed over or near the air
bag on the instrument panel, because any such
objects could cause harm if the vehicle is in a
collision severe enough to cause the air bag to
inflate.
• Do not put anything on or around the air bag
covers or attempt to open them manually. You may
damage the air bags and you could be injured
because the air bags may no longer be functional.
The protective covers for the air bag cushions are
designed to open only when the air bags are
inflating.
• Relying on the air bags alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The air bags work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
(Continued)
some collisions, air bags won’t deploy at all. Always wear your seat belts even though you have air
bags.
Advanced Front Air Bag Operation
Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to provide additional protection by supplementing the seat belts. Advanced Front Air Bags are not expected to reduce the risk
of injury in rear, side, or rollover collisions. The Advanced Front Air Bags will not deploy in all frontal
collisions, including some that may produce substantial
vehicle damage — for example, some pole collisions,
truck underrides, and angle offset collisions.
On the other hand, depending on the type and location of
impact, Advanced Front Air Bags may deploy in crashes
with little vehicle front-end damage but that produce a
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 45
severe initial deceleration. Because air bag sensors mea- Supplemental Door-Integrated Side Air Bag
sure vehicle deceleration over time, vehicle speed and Inflatable Curtains (SABICs)
damage by themselves are not good indicators of
whether or not an air bag should have deployed.
Seat belts are necessary for your protection in all collisions, and also are needed to help keep you in position,
away from an inflating air bag.
When the ORC detects a collision requiring the Advanced Front Air Bags, it signals the inflator units. A large
quantity of non-toxic gas is generated to inflate the
Advanced Front Air Bags.
The steering wheel hub trim cover and the upper right
side of the instrument panel separate and fold out of the
way as the air bags inflate to their full size. The Advanced
Supplemental Door-Integrated Side Air Bag Inflatable
Front Air Bags fully inflate in less time than it takes to
Curtains (SABICs)
blink your eyes. The air bags then quickly deflate while
This vehicle is equipped with Supplemental Doorhelping to restrain the driver and front passenger.
Integrated Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABICs).
2
46 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
SABICs may help reduce the risk of head injury to front
seat outboard occupants in certain side impacts. SABICs
may reduce the risk of injuries in certain side impacts, in
addition to the injury reduction potential provided by the
seat belts and body structure. The SABICs are located in
the door trim below the side windows. The trim covering
the SABICs is labeled AIRBAG.
The SABICs may help reduce the risk of partial or
complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side
windows in certain side impact events.
SABICs are designed to activate in certain side impacts.
The Occupant Restraint Controller (“ORC”) determines
whether the deployment of the SABIC in a particular
impact event is appropriate, based on the severity and
type of collision. The side impact sensors aid the ORC in
determining the appropriate response to impact events.
The system is calibrated to deploy the SABIC on the
impact side of the vehicle during impacts that require
SABIC occupant protection. In side impacts, the SABICs
deploy independently; a left side impact deploys the left
side SABIC only and a right-side impact deploys the
right side SABIC only. Vehicle damage by itself is not a
good indicator of whether or not SABICs should have
deployed.
The SABICs deploy upward, covering the side windows.
An inflating SABIC pushes the outside edge of the trim
out of the way and covers the window. The SABICs
inflate with enough force to injure you if you are not
SABICs will not deploy in all side collisions, including
belted and seated properly, or if items are positioned in
some collisions at certain angles, or some side collisions
the area where the SABICs inflate. Children are at an
that do not impact the area of the passenger comparteven greater risk of injury from a deploying air bag.
ment. SABICs may deploy during angled or offset frontal
collisions where the Advanced Front Air Bags deploy.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 47
SABICs are a supplement to the seat belt restraint system.
SABICs deploy in less time than it takes to blink your
eyes. Occupants, including children, who are up against
or very close to SABICs can be seriously injured or killed.
Occupants, including children, should never lean on or
sleep against the door, side windows, or area where the
side air bags inflate, even if they are in an infant or child
restraint.
Seat belts (and child restraints where appropriate) are
necessary for your protection in all collisions. They also
help keep you in position, away from an inflating SABIC.
To get the best protection from the SABICs, occupants
must wear their seat belts properly and sit upright with
their backs against the seats. Children must be properly
restrained in a child restraint or booster seat that is
appropriate for the size of the child.
WARNING!
• Your vehicle is equipped with left and right
Supplemental Door-Integrated Side Air Bag Inflatable Curtains (SABICs). Do not stack luggage or
other cargo up high enough to block the deployment of the SABICs. The door trim below the side
windows where the SABIC and its deployment
path are located, should remain free from any
obstructions.
• SABICs need room to inflate. Do not lean against
the door or window. Sit upright in the center of the
seat.
• Being too close to the SABICs during deployment
could cause you to be severely injured or killed.
(Continued)
2
48 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Relying on the SABICs alone could lead to more
severe injuries in a collision. The SABICs work
with your seat belt to restrain you properly. In
some collisions, SABICs won’t deploy at all. Always wear your seat belt even though you have
SABICs.
NOTE: Air bag covers may not be obvious to you, but
they will open during air bag deployment.
Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
Knee Impact Bolsters
The Knee Impact Bolsters help protect the knees of the
driver and front passenger, and position the front occupants for improved interaction with the Advanced Front
Air Bags.
WARNING!
• Do not drill, cut, or tamper with the knee impact
bolsters in any way.
• Do not mount any accessories to the knee impact
bolsters such as alarm lights, stereos, citizen band
radios, etc.
This vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Driver
Knee Air Bag mounted in the instrument panel below the
If A Deployment Occurs
steering column. The Supplemental Driver Knee Air Bag
provides enhanced protection during a frontal impact by The Advanced Front Air Bags are designed to deflate
working together with the seat belts, pretensioners, and immediately after deployment.
Advanced Front Air Bags.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 49
NOTE: Front and/or side air bags will not deploy in all
collisions. This does not mean something is wrong with
the air bag system.
If you do have a collision, which deploys the air bags, any
or all of the following may occur:
skin, eyes, nose, or throat. If you have skin or eye
irritation, rinse the area with cool water. For nose or
throat irritation, move to fresh air. If the irritation
continues, see your doctor. If these particles settle on
your clothing, follow the garment manufacturer’s instructions for cleaning.
• The air bag material may sometimes cause abrasions
Do not drive your vehicle after the air bags have deand/or skin reddening to the occupants as the air bags
ployed. If you are involved in another collision, the air
deploy and unfold. The abrasions are similar to fricbags will not be in place to protect you.
tion rope burns or those you might get sliding along a
carpet or gymnasium floor. They are not caused by
WARNING!
contact with chemicals. They are not permanent and
normally heal quickly. However, if you haven’t healed Deployed air bags and seat belt pretensioners cannot
significantly within a few days, or if you have any protect you in another collision. Have the air bags,
blistering, see your doctor immediately.
seat belt pretensioners, and the seat belt retractor
• As the air bags deflate, you may see some smoke-like assemblies replaced by an authorized dealer immeparticles. The particles are a normal by-product of the diately. Also, have the Occupant Restraint Controller
process that generates the non-toxic gas used for air System serviced as well.
bag inflation. These airborne particles may irritate the
(Continued)
2
50 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as
the battery has power or until the ignition is cycled to
• Air bag covers may not be obvious in the interior trim,
OFF.
but they will open during air bag deployment.
• Unlock the doors automatically.
• After any collision, the vehicle should be taken to an
System Reset Procedure
authorized dealer immediately.
NOTE:
Enhanced Accident Response System
In the event of an impact, if the communication network
remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending
on the nature of the event the ORC will determine
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response System perform the following functions:
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
until the ignition is cycled to OFF.
Depending on the nature of the event the left and right
turn signal lights, located in the instrument panel, may
both be blinking and will continue to blink until the
ignition switch is turned to the OFF position. In order to
move your vehicle to the side of the road, you must
follow the system reset procedure.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 51
Customer Action
1. Turn ignition OFF.
(Turn Signal Switch Must
be placed in Neutral
State).
2. Turn ignition ON.
3. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
4. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
5. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
Customer Will See
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Customer Action
6. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
7. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch OFF. (Turn Signal
Switch Must be placed in
Neutral State).
8. Turn ignition OFF.
Customer Will See
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
is ON SOLID.
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light is OFF.
System is now reset and
the engine may be
started.
9. Turn Hazard Flashers
OFF (Manually).
If a reset procedure step is not completed within 45
seconds, then the turn signal lights will turn off and the
reset procedure must be performed again in order to be
successful.
2
52 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
ON/RUN position. After the self-check, the Air Bag
Warning Light will turn off. If the ORC detects a malThe air bags must be ready to inflate for your protection
function in any part of the system, it turns on the Air Bag
in a collision. The Air Bag Warning Light
Warning Light, either momentarily or continuously. A
monitors the internal circuits and interconnectsingle chime will sound to alert you if the light comes on
ing wiring associated with air bag system elecagain after initial startup.
trical components.
The ORC also includes diagnostics that will illuminate
The ORC monitors the readiness of the electronic parts of
the instrument cluster Air Bag Warning Light if a malthe air bag system whenever the ignition switch is in the
function is detected that could affect the air bag system.
START or ON/RUN position. If the ignition switch is in
The diagnostics also record the nature of the malfunction.
the OFF position the air bag system is not on and the air
While the air bag system is designed to be maintenance
bags will not inflate.
free, if any of the following occurs, have an authorized
The ORC contains a backup power supply system that dealer service the air bag system immediately.
may deploy the air bags even if the battery loses power or
• The Air Bag Warning Light does not come on during
it becomes disconnected prior to deployment.
the four to eight seconds when the ignition switch is
Also, the ORC turns on the Air Bag Warning Light in the
first turned to the ON/RUN position.
instrument panel for approximately four to eight seconds
• The Air Bag Warning Light remains on after the four to
for a self-check when the ignition is first turned to the
eight-second interval.
Air Bag Warning Light
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 53
• The Air Bag Warning Light comes on intermittently or Maintaining Your Air Bag System
remains on while driving.
NOTE: If the speedometer, tachometer, or any engine
related gauges are not working, the Occupant Restraint
Controller (ORC) may also be disabled. In this condition
the air bags may not be ready to inflate for your protection. Have an authorized dealer service the air bag
system immediately.
WARNING!
Ignoring the Air Bag Warning Light in your instrument panel could mean you won’t have the air bags
to protect you in a collision. If the light does not come
on as a bulb check when the ignition is first placed in
the on position, and stays on after you start the
vehicle, or if it comes on as you drive, have an
authorized dealer service the air bag system immediately.
WARNING!
2
• Modifications to any part of the air bag system
could cause it to fail when you need it. You could
be injured if the air bag system is not there to
protect you. Do not modify the components or
wiring, including adding any kind of badges or
stickers to the steering wheel hub trim cover or the
upper right side of the instrument panel. Do not
modify the front bumper, vehicle body structure, or
add aftermarket side steps or running boards.
• It is dangerous to try to repair any part of the air
bag system yourself. Be sure to tell anyone who
works on your vehicle that it has an air bag system.
(Continued)
54 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not attempt to modify any part of your air bag
system. The air bag may inflate accidentally or may
not function properly if modifications are made.
Take your vehicle to an authorized dealer for any
air bag system service. If your seat, including your
trim cover and cushion, needs to be serviced in any
way (including removal or loosening/tightening of
seat attachment bolts), take the vehicle to your
authorized dealer. Only manufacturer approved
seat accessories may be used. If it is necessary to
modify the air bag system for persons with disabilities, contact your authorized dealer.
Event Data Recorder
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder
(EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in
certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air
bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will
assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to
vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle
is designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger seat belts
were buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was pushing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 55
These data can help provide a better understanding of Child Restraints
the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
Everyone in your vehicle needs to be buckled up at all
NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a times, including babies and children. Every state in the
non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by United States, and every Canadian province, requires
the EDR under normal driving conditions and no per- that small children ride in proper restraint systems. This
sonal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) is the law, and you can be prosecuted for ignoring it.
are recorded. However, other parties, such as law en- Children 12 years or younger should ride properly
forcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of buckled up in a rear seat, if available. According to crash
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a statistics, children are safer when properly restrained in
crash investigation.
the rear seats rather than in the front.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is
required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed.
In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties,
such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the
vehicle or the EDR.
2
56 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING!
In a collision, an unrestrained child can become a
projectile inside the vehicle. The force required to
hold even an infant on your lap could become so
great that you could not hold the child, no matter
how strong you are. The child and others could be
badly injured. Any child riding in your vehicle
should be in a proper restraint for the child’s size.
There are different sizes and types of restraints for
children from newborn size to the child almost large
enough for an adult seat belt. Always check the child seat
Owner’s Manual to make sure you have the correct seat
for your child. Carefully read and follow all the instructions and warnings in the child restraint Owner’s Manual
and on all the labels attached to the child restraint.
Before buying any restraint system, make sure that it has
a label certifying that it meets all applicable Safety
Standards. You should also make sure that you can install
it in the vehicle where you will use it.
NOTE: For additional information, refer to
www.seatcheck.org or call 1–866–SEATCHECK. Canadian residents should refer to Transport Canada’s website for additional information: http://www.tc.gc.ca/
eng/roadsafety/safedrivers-childsafety-index-53.htm
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 57
Summary Of Recommendations For Restraining Children In Vehicles
Infants and Toddlers
Small Children
Larger Children
Children Too Large for
Child Restraints
Child Size, Height, Weight or Age
Children who are two years old or
younger and who have not reached the
height or weight limits of their child
restraint
Children who are at least two years old
or who have out-grown the height or
weight limit of their rear-facing child
restraint
Children who have out-grown their
forward-facing child restraint, but are
too small to properly fit the vehicle’s
seat belt
Children 12 years old or younger, who
have out-grown the height or weight
limit of their booster seat
Recommended Type of Child Restraint
Either an Infant Carrier or a Convertible
Child Restraint, facing rearward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Forward-Facing Child Restraint with a
five-point Harness, facing forward in the
rear seat of the vehicle
Belt Positioning Booster Seat and the
vehicle seat belt, seated in the rear seat
of the vehicle
Vehicle Seat Belt, seated in the rear seat
of the vehicle
2
58 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Infant and Child Restraints
Safety experts recommend that children ride rear-facing
in the vehicle until they are two years old or until they
reach either the height or weight limit of their rear-facing
child restraint. Two types of child restraints can be used
rear-facing: infant carriers and convertible child seats.
The infant carrier is only used rear-facing in the vehicle.
It is recommended for children from birth until they
reach the weight or height limit of the infant carrier.
Convertible child seats can be used either rear-facing or
forward-facing in the vehicle. Convertible child seats
often have a higher weight limit in the rear-facing
direction than infant carriers do, so they can be used
rear-facing by children who have outgrown their infant
carrier but are still less than at least two years old.
Children should remain rear-facing until they reach the
highest weight or height allowed by their convertible
child seat.
WARNING!
• Never place a rear-facing child restraint in front of
an air bag. A deploying Passenger Advanced Front
Air Bag can cause death or serious injury to a child
12 years or younger, including a child in a rearfacing child restraint.
• Only use rear-facing child restraint in a vehicle
with a rear seat.
Older Children And Child Restraints
Children who are two years old or who have outgrown
their rear-facing convertible child seat can ride forwardfacing in the vehicle. Forward-facing child seats and
convertible child seats used in the forward-facing direction are for children who are over two years old or who
have outgrown the rear-facing weight or height limit of
their rear-facing convertible child seat. Children should
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 59
remain in a forward-facing child seat with a harness for
as long as possible, up to the highest weight or height
allowed by the child seat.
All children whose weight or height is above the
forward-facing limit for the child seat should use a
belt-positioning booster seat until the vehicle’s seat belts
fit properly. If the child cannot sit with knees bent over
the vehicle’s seat cushion while the child’s back is against
the seatback, they should use a belt-positioning booster
seat. The child and belt-positioning booster seat are held
in the vehicle by the seat belt.
WARNING!
• Improper installation can lead to failure of an
infant or child restraint. It could come loose in a
collision. The child could be badly injured or
killed. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
directions exactly when installing an infant or
child restraint.
• After a child restraint is installed in the vehicle, do
not move the vehicle seat forward or rearward
because it can loosen the child restraint attachments. Remove the child restraint before adjusting
the vehicle seat position. When the vehicle seat has
been adjusted, reinstall the child restraint.
• When your child restraint is not in use, secure it in
the vehicle with the seat belt or LATCH anchorages, or remove it from the vehicle. Do not leave it
loose in the vehicle. In a sudden stop or accident, it
could strike the occupants or seatbacks and cause
serious personal injury.
2
60 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Children Too Large For Booster Seats
5. Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?
Children who are large enough to wear the shoulder belt
comfortably, and whose legs are long enough to bend
over the front of the seat when their back is against the
seatback, should use the seat belt in a rear seat. Use this
simple 5-step test to decide whether the child can use the
vehicle’s seat belt alone:
If the answer to any of these questions was “no,” then the
child still needs to use a booster seat in this vehicle. If the
child is using the lap/shoulder belt, check belt fit periodically and make sure the seat belt buckle is latched. A
child’s squirming or slouching can move the belt out of
position. If the shoulder belt contacts the face or neck,
move the child closer to the center of the vehicle, or use
a booster seat to position the seat belt on the child
correctly.
1. Can the child sit all the way back against the back of
the vehicle seat?
2. Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over the front
of the vehicle seat – while they are still sitting all the
way back?
3. Does the shoulder belt cross the child’s shoulder
between their neck and arm?
4. Is the lap part of the belt as low as possible, touching
the child’s thighs and not their stomach?
WARNING!
Never allow a child to put the shoulder belt under an
arm or behind their back. In a crash, the shoulder belt
will not protect a child properly, which may result in
serious injury or death. A child must always wear
both the lap and shoulder portions of the seat belt
correctly.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 61
Installing Child Restraints Using The Vehicle Seat
Belt
Lap/Shoulder Belt Systems For Installing Child
Restraints In This Vehicle
The seat belt in the front passenger seat is equipped with
a Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR). This
type of seat belt is designed to keep the lap portion of the
seat belt tight around the child restraint so that it is not
necessary to use a locking clip. The ALR retractor can be
“switched” into a locked mode by pulling all of the
webbing out of the retractor and then letting the webbing
retract back into the retractor. If it is locked, the ALR will
make a clicking noise while the webbing is pulled back
into the retractor. For additional information on ALR,
refer to “Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know
Before Starting Your Vehicle.”
2
The image below defines the type of feature for each
seating position.
• ALR = Switchable Automatic Locking Retractor
•
Top Tether Anchorage Symbol
62 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
What is the weight limit (child’s
weight + weight of the child restraint) for using the Tether Anchor
with the seat belt to attach a forward
facing child restraint?
Can the head restraints be removed?
Can the buckle stalk be twisted to
tighten the seat belt against the belt
path of the child restraint?
Weight limit of the Child Restraint
Installing A Child Restraint With A Switchable
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR):
Always use the tether anchor when
using the seat belt to install a forward facing child restraint, up to
the recommended weight limit of
the child restraint.
No
No
Do not twist the buckle stalk in a
seating position with an ALR retractor.
2. Pull enough of the seat belt webbing from the retractor
to pass it through the belt path of the child restraint.
Do not twist the belt webbing in the belt path.
1. Place the child seat in the center of the seating
position. Move the vehicle seat as far rearward as 3. Slide the latch plate into the buckle until you hear a
possible to keep the child as far from the advanced
“click.”
passenger air bag as possible.
4. Pull on the webbing to make the lap portion tight
against the child seat.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 63
strap. See the section “Installing Child Restraints
5. To lock the seat belt, pull down on the shoulder part of
the belt until you have pulled all the seat belt webbing
Using The Top Tether Anchorage” for directions to
attach a tether anchor.
out of the retractor. Then, allow the webbing to retract
back into the retractor. As the webbing retracts, you
9. Test that the child restraint is installed tightly by
will hear a clicking sound. This means the seat belt is
pulling back and forth on the child seat at the belt
now in the Automatic Locking mode.
path. It should not move more than 1 inch (25.4 mm)
6. Try to pull the webbing out of the retractor. If it is
in any direction.
locked, you should not be able to pull out any webAny seat belt system will loosen with time, so check the
bing. If the retractor is not locked, repeat step 5.
belt occasionally, and pull it tight if necessary.
7. Finally, pull up on any excess webbing to tighten the Installing Child Restraints Using The Top Tether
lap portion around the child restraint while you push Anchorage:
the child restraint rearward and downward into the
vehicle seat.
WARNING!
8. If the child restraint has a top tether strap and the
seating position has a top tether anchorage, connect
the tether strap to the anchorage and tighten the tether
Do not attach a tether strap for a rear-facing car seat
to any location in front of the car seat, including the
seat frame or a tether anchorage. Only attach the
(Continued)
2
64 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
WARNING! (Continued)
tether strap of a rear-facing car seat to the tether
anchorage that is approved for that seating position,
located behind the top of the vehicle seat. See the
section “Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren
(LATCH) Restraint System” for the location of approved tether anchorages in your vehicle.
Always use the tether anchor when using the seat belt to
install a forward facing child restraint, up to the recommended weight limit of the child restraint. This vehicle is
equipped with a tether anchorage, located behind the
front passenger seat, near the floor.
Upper Tether Anchorage
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 65
1. Look behind the seating position where you plan to
install the child restraint to find the tether anchorage.
You may need to tilt the seatback forward to provide
better access to the tether anchorage.
Transporting Pets
Deploying air bags could harm your pet. An unrestrained
pet will be thrown about and possibly injured, or injure a
passenger during panic braking or in an collision.
2. Route the tether strap around the outboard side of the Pets should be restrained in pet harnesses or pet carriers
head restraint to the tether anchorage.
that are secured by seat belts.
3. Attach the tether strap hook of the child restraint to
ENGINE BREAK-IN RECOMMENDATIONS
the top tether anchorage.
A long break-in period is not required for the drivetrain
4. Remove slack in the tether strap according to the child (engine, transmission, and rear axle) in your new vehicle.
restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
Following these few simple guidelines is all that is
necessary for a good break-in.
WARNING!
An incorrectly anchored tether strap could lead to
increased head motion and possible injury to the
child. Use only the anchorage position directly behind the child seat to secure a child restraint top
tether strap.
For the first 200 miles (300 km):
• Driving your vehicle with new transmission requires
no special techniques but, to reach optimal shifting
quality, it’s preferred to use only Natural DNA mode
in the first 125 miles (200 km), avoiding in this phase
very aggressive driving.
2
66 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
• Avoid driving at a constant speed, either fast or slow, SAFETY TIPS
for long periods.
Transporting Passengers
• Do not make any full throttle starts and avoid full NEVER TRANSPORT PASSENGERS IN THE CARGO
throttle acceleration while cruising within the posted AREA.
speed limits of local traffic laws.
• Use the proper gear for your speed range.
• Wait until the engine has reached normal operating
temperature before driving at the recommended maximum break-in speed.
• Avoid excessive idling.
• Check the engine oil level at every fuel fill.
NOTE: A new engine will consume some oil during the
first few thousand miles (kilometers) of operation. This
should be considered a normal part of the break-in and
not interpreted as a sign of difficulty.
WARNING!
• Do not leave children or animals inside parked
vehicles in hot weather. Interior heat build-up may
cause serious injury or death.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people
riding in these areas are more likely to be seriously
injured or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle
that is not equipped with seats and seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 67
Exhaust Gas
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain carbon
monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless.
Breathing it can make you unconscious and can
eventually poison you. To avoid breathing (CO),
follow these safety tips:
• Do not run the engine in a closed garage or in
confined areas any longer than needed to move
your vehicle in or out of the area.
• If you are required to drive with the trunk/liftgate/
rear doors open, make sure that all windows are
closed and the climate control BLOWER switch is
set at high speed. DO NOT use the recirculation
mode.
(Continued)
• If it is necessary to sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running, adjust your heating or cooling
controls to force outside air into the vehicle. Set the
blower at high speed.
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
Whenever a change is noticed in the sound of the exhaust
system, when exhaust fumes can be detected inside the
vehicle, or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is
damaged, have a competent mechanic inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken,
damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open
seams or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes
to seep into the passenger compartment. In addition,
inspect the exhaust system each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
2
68 THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE
Safety Checks You Should Make Inside The
Vehicle
Seat Belts
authorized dealer. If the light stays on, flickers, or comes
on while driving, have the system checked by an authorized dealer.
Inspect the belt system periodically, checking for cuts, Defroster
frays, and loose parts. Damaged parts must be replaced Check operation by selecting the defrost mode and place
immediately. Do not disassemble or modify the system. the blower control on high speed. You should be able to
feel the air directed against the windshield. See your
Front seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
authorized dealer for service if your defroster is inopercollision. Seat belt assemblies must be replaced after a
able.
collision if they have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor,
torn webbing, etc.). If there is any question regarding belt Floor Mat Safety Information
or retractor condition, replace the belt.
Always use floor mats designed to fit the foot well of
your vehicle. Use only floor mats that leave the pedal
area unobstructed and that are firmly secured so that
The light should come on and remain on for four to eight
they cannot slip out of position and interfere with the
seconds as a bulb check when the ignition is first cycled
pedals or impair safe operation of your vehicle in other
to ON. If the light is not lit during starting, see your
ways.
Air Bag Warning Light
THINGS TO KNOW BEFORE STARTING YOUR VEHICLE 69
Periodic Safety Checks You Should Make Outside
The Vehicle
Door Latches
Tires
Fluid Leaks
Examine tires for excessive tread wear and uneven wear
patterns. Check for stones, nails, glass, or other objects
lodged in the tread. Inspect the tread and sidewall for
cuts and cracks. Check the wheel nuts for tightness.
Check the tires for proper pressure.
Lights
Have someone observe the operation of brake lights and
exterior lights while you work the controls. Check turn
signal and high beam indicator lights on the instrument
panel.
Check for positive closing, latching, and locking.
Check area under vehicle after overnight parking for fuel,
engine coolant, oil, or other fluid leaks. Also, if gasoline
fumes are detected or if fuel, power steering fluid (if
equipped), or brake fluid leaks are suspected, the cause
should be located and corrected immediately.
2
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 MIRRORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74 䡵 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
▫ Inside Day/Night Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
▫ Multifunction Lever. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83
▫ Outside Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
▫ Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
▫ Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
▫ Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Folding Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
▫ High Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Heated Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
▫ Flash-To-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
䡵 SEATS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
▫ Parking Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
▫ Turn Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
▫ Non-Adjustable Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . .80
▫ Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
䡵 TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE DECKLID . . . . . . .80
3
72 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay — If
Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
▫ Dimmer Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
▫ Interior Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
䡵 WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS . . . . . .89
▫ Intermittent Wiper System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Windshield Wiper Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Mist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
▫ Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90
䡵 TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN . . . .91
▫ To Deactivate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
▫ To Resume Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
▫ To Vary The Speed Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
▫ To Accelerate For Passing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95
䡵 PARKING SENSORS — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . .96
▫ Activation/Deactivation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
▫ Acoustic Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96
▫ Indications On Display — If Equipped . . . . . . .97
▫ Fault Indication. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
▫ General Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
䡵 ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL —
䡵 POWER OUTLETS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
䡵 CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
▫ To Activate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
EQUIPPED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
▫ To Set A Desired Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 73
䡵 CUPHOLDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
▫ Console Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
䡵 STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
▫ Rear Compartment Storage. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105
▫ Seatback Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
3
74 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
MIRRORS
Inside Day/Night Mirror
A single ball joint mirror is provided in the vehicle. It is
a twist on mirror that has a fixed position at the windshield. The mirror installs on the windshield button with
a counterclockwise rotation and requires no tools for
mounting. The mirror head can be adjusted up, down,
left, and right for various drivers. The mirror should be
adjusted to center on the view through the rear window.
Headlight glare from vehicles behind you can be reduced
by moving the small control under the mirror to the night
position (toward the rear of the vehicle). The mirror
should be adjusted while the small control under the
mirror is set in the day position (toward the windshield).
Adjusting Rearview Mirror
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 75
Outside Mirrors
Power Mirrors
To receive maximum benefit, adjust the outside mirrors The power mirror controls are located on the center
to center on the adjacent lane of traffic and a slight console.
overlap of the view obtained from the inside mirror.
NOTE: The passenger side convex outside mirror will
give a much wider view to the rear, and especially of the
lane next to your vehicle.
WARNING!
Vehicles and other objects seen in the passenger side
convex mirror will look smaller and farther away
than they really are. Relying too much on your
passenger side mirror could cause you to collide with
another vehicle or other object. Use your inside
mirror when judging the size or distance of a vehicle
seen in the passenger side mirror.
Power Mirror Control
3
76 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
The power mirror controls consist of mirror select knob
and a four-way mirror control switch. To adjust a mirror,
turn the power mirror control knob to the left or right to
select the mirror that you want to adjust.
Using the mirror control switch, press on any of the four
arrows for the direction that you want the mirror to
move.
Folding Mirrors
The exterior mirrors are hinged to allow the mirror to
pivot forward or rearward to help avoid damage. The
mirror has three detent positions: full forward, full rearward and normal.
Folding Mirrors
Heated Mirrors
These mirrors are heated to melt frost or ice.
This feature can be activated whenever you
turn on the mirror defroster.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 77
SEATS
Manual Seats
Seats are a part of the Occupant Restraint System of the Forward And Rearward Adjustment
vehicle.
The adjusting bar is at the front of the driver seat, near
the floor. Pull the bar upward to move the seat forward or
WARNING!
rearward. Release the bar once the seat is in the desired
• It is dangerous to ride in a cargo area, inside or position. Then, using body pressure, move forward and
outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in rearward on the seat to be sure that the seat adjusters
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured have latched.
or killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any area of your
vehicle that is not equipped with seats and seat
belts. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or killed.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and
using a seat belt properly.
3
78 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Recliner Adjustment
The recliner lever is located on the outboard side of the
seat. To recline the seat, lean forward slightly, pull the
recliner lever upward, lean backward until the seat is in
the desired position, and release the lever. To return the
seat to its full upright position, lean forward, pull the
recliner lever upward and hold it until the seat returns to
its full upright position.
Seat Adjustment Bar
Seat Height Adjustment
In order to achieve the ideal driving position, the height
of the seats can also be adjusted. Tools are required to
make this height adjustment. Contact your authorized
dealership.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 79
WARNING!
Recline Lever
• Adjusting a seat while driving may be dangerous.
Moving a seat while driving could result in loss of
control which could cause a collision and serious
injury or death.
• Seats should be adjusted before fastening the seat
belts and while the vehicle is parked. Serious
injury or death could result from a poorly adjusted
seat belt.
• Do not ride with the seatback reclined so that the
shoulder belt is no longer resting against your chest.
In a collision you could slide under the seat belt,
which could result in serious injury or death.
3
80 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Non-Adjustable Head Restraints
The non-adjustable head restraints are form fitted into
the upper structure of the seatback and are designed to
reduce the risk of injury by restricting head movement in
the event of a rear impact. The seatback should be
properly adjusted to an upright position where the head
restraint is positioned as close as possible to the back of
your head.
WARNING!
Be certain that the seatback is locked securely into
position. Otherwise, the seat will not provide the
proper stability for passengers. An improperly
latched seatback could cause serious injury.
TO OPEN AND CLOSE THE DECKLID
CAUTION!
• To prevent possible damage, do not slam the decklid to close it. Use a firm downward push at the
center of the decklid to ensure the decklid latch is
fully engaged.
• During normal car operation, the luggage compartment (located rear of the engine) can reach temperatures above 149 degrees. Do not transport objects in the luggage compartment that may be
damaged at such temperatures. Do not place aerosol cans in the luggage compartment.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 81
To open the decklid:
3. Move to the rear of the vehicle and lift the decklid.
1. Open the drivers side door.
2. Pull the decklid release lever located on the rear of the
drivers door sill.
3
Decklid Lift Point Location
Decklid Release Lever
82 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
4. Lift upward on the decklid prop rod to release it from 5. Place the decklid prop rod in the decklid slot to secure
the stowage retainer.
the decklid in the open position.
1 — Decklid Prop Rod
2 — Stowage Retainer Location
Decklid Prop Rod Slot
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 83
CAUTION!
WARNING! (Continued)
To prevent possible damage, do not slam the decklid
to close it. Use a firm downward push at the center of
the decklid to ensure the decklid latch is fully
engaged.
WARNING!
• The maximum load limit for the luggage compartment, in addition to the kits provided, is 33.1 lbs.
(15kg). Do not exceed the maximum permitted load
in the luggage compartment. When accessing the
rear luggage compartment, do not come into contact with engine, or other components, that may be
hot and could burn you if touched.
(Continued)
• Access the luggage compartment only with the
vehicle stationary. Before exiting the vehicle, you
should always place the vehicle into First gear,
apply the parking brake, and remove the key from
the ignition. Never leave the key fob in the vehicle
or in a location accessible to children.
• The decklid may drop suddenly, causing serious
injury, if the supporting rod is not positioned
correctly.
• The decklid must always be closed properly, and
the lock engaged, while the vehicle is in motions.
LIGHTS
Multifunction Lever
The multifunction lever, located on the left side of the
steering wheel, controls the operation of the headlights,
headlight beam selection, passing light and turn signals.
3
84 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The external lights can only be turned on with Headlights
the ignition in the ON/RUN position.
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever upward to the first detent for headlight operation.
Multifunction Lever
Headlight Operation
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 85
NOTE: When the headlights are turned on, the Daytime Flash-To-Pass
Running Lights will be deactivated.
You can signal another vehicle with your headlights by
partially pulling the multifunction lever toward the steerDaytime Running Lights
ing wheel. This will cause the high beam headlights to
To activate the Daytime Running Lights (DRL), rotate the
turn on until the lever is released.
end of the multifunction lever to the O symbol.
Parking Lights
NOTE: The low beams and side/tail lights will not be on
with DRL.
To turn on the parking lights, remove the key
High Beams
or turn the ignition to OFF/LOCK position and
turn on the headlights.
With the low beams activated, pull the multifunction lever towards the steering wheel to turn on Turn Signals
the high beams. A high beam symbol will illuminate in Move the multifunction lever up or down and the arrows
the cluster to indicate the high beams are on. Pull the on each side of the instrument cluster flash to show
multifunction lever a second time to switch the head- proper operation of the front and rear turn signal lights.
lights back to low beam.
3
86 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If either light remains on and does not flash, or
there is a very fast flash rate, check for a defective outside
light bulb. If an indicator fails to light when the lever is
moved, it would suggest that the indicator bulb is
defective.
Lane Change Assist
Activation
Remove the key or turn the ignition to the OFF/LOCK
position, and pull the multifunction lever toward the
steering wheel, within two minutes. Each time the lever
is pulled, the activation of the lights will be extended by
30 seconds. The activation of the lights can be extended to
a maximum of 210 seconds.
Tap the lever up or down once, without moving beyond
the detent, and the turn signal (right or left) will flash five Deactivation
times then automatically turn off.
Pull the multifunction lever toward the steering wheel
and hold it for more than two seconds.
Follow Me Home/Headlight Delay — If Equipped
When this feature is selected the driver can choose to
have the headlights remain on for a preset period of time.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 87
Dimmer Controls
Interior Light
The dimmer controls are located on the left side of the The interior light is located in the headliner in between
instrument panel below the instrument cluster.
the sun visors. The interior light can be set to three
different positions (Off/Left Position, Center Position,
On/Right Position).
Using the interior light lens, press the lens to the right
from its center position and the lights are always on.
Press the lens to the left from its center position and the
lights are always off. Leave the lens in the center position,
and the light is turned on and off when the doors are
opened or closed.
Dimmer Controls
Pressing the up or down arrow will increase or decrease
the brightness of the instrument panel lights.
3
88 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Before getting out of the vehicle be sure that the
switch is in the center position or that the lights are
off to avoid draining the battery.
Interior Light Timing (Center Position)
There are four different modes of operation that can be
activated in this position:
• When one door is opened a three minute timer is
activated.
• When the key is removed from the ignition (within
two minutes of the ignition being turned off), a 10
second timer is activated.
• When the doors are unlocked with the Key Fob a 10
second timer is activated.
• When the doors are locked with the Key Fob the lights
will turn off.
Interior Light (Off Position Shown)
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 89
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHERS
Intermittent Wiper System
The windshield wiper/washer controls are located on the
windshield wiper/washer lever on the right side of the
steering column. The front wipers are operated by rotating a switch, located on the end of the lever.
Use the intermittent wiper when weather conditions
make a single wiping cycle with a variable pause between cycles. Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to
the first detent position. There are four possible delay
intervals that depend on the vehicle speed.
Windshield Wiper Operation
Rotate the end of the lever upward, to the first detent past
the intermittent settings for low-speed wiper operation.
Rotate the end of the lever upward to the second detent
past the intermittent settings for high-speed wiper operation.
Mist
Windshield Wiper/Washer Lever
Use the mist feature when weather conditions make
occasional usage of the wipers necessary. Push the lever
upward to the mist position and release for a single
wiping cycle.
3
90 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The mist feature does not activate the washer
pump; therefore, no washer fluid will be sprayed on the
windshield. The wash function must be used in order to
spray the windshield with washer fluid.
Windshield Washers
To use the washer, pull the lever toward you and hold
while spray is desired. If the lever is pulled while in the
delay range, the wiper will start and continue to operate
for three wipe cycles after the lever is released, and then
resume the intermittent interval previously selected.
If the lever is pulled while in the off position, the wipers
will operate for three wipe cycles and then turn off.
WARNING!
Sudden loss of visibility through the windshield
could lead to a collision. You might not see other
vehicles or other obstacles. To avoid sudden icing of
the windshield during freezing weather, warm the
windshield with defroster before and during windshield washer use.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 91
TILT/TELESCOPING STEERING COLUMN
This feature allows you to tilt the steering column
upward or downward. It also allows you to lengthen or
shorten the steering column. The tilt/telescoping control
handle is located below the steering wheel at the end of
the steering column.
To unlock the steering column, push the lever downward
(toward the floor). To tilt the steering column, move the
steering wheel upward or downward as desired. To
lengthen or shorten the steering column, pull the steering
wheel outward or push it inward as desired. To lock the
steering column in position, push the lever upward until
fully engaged.
WARNING!
Do not adjust the steering column while driving.
Adjusting the steering column while driving or driving with the steering column unlocked, could cause
the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Failure to
follow this warning may result in serious injury or
death.
Tilt/Telescoping Column Lever
3
92 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
ELECTRONIC SPEED CONTROL — IF EQUIPPED
When engaged, the Electronic Speed Control takes over
accelerator operations at speeds greater than 18 mph
(30 km/h) up to the maximum speed of 105 mph
(170 km/h).
The Electronic Speed Control Lever is located on the left
side of the steering column.
NOTE: In order to ensure proper operation, the Electronic Speed Control system has been designed to shut
down if multiple speed control functions are operated at
the same time. If this occurs, the Electronic Speed Control
system can be reactivated rotating the end of the multifunction lever (On/Off) and resetting the desired vehicle
set speed.
Electronic Speed Control Lever
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 93
To Activate
To Set A Desired Speed
Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to activate the
Electronic Speed Control. The Cruise Indicator Light in
the Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) will
illuminate. To turn the system off, rotate the end of the
multifunction lever to the “O” position. The Cruise
Indicator Light will turn off. The system should be
turned off when not in use.
Turn the Electronic Speed Control ON. When the vehicle
has reached the desired speed, move the electronic speed
control lever upward SET(+) and release. Release the
accelerator and the vehicle will operate at the selected
speed.
WARNING!
Leaving the Electronic Speed Control system on
when not in use is dangerous. You could accidentally
set the system or cause it to go faster than you want.
You could lose control and have an accident. Always
leave the system OFF when you are not using it.
NOTE: The vehicle should be traveling at a steady speed
and on level ground before moving the electronic speed
control lever upward SET(+).
To Deactivate
A soft tap on the brake pedal, pushing the RESUME/
CANCEL button, or normal brake pressure while slowing the vehicle will deactivate Electronic Speed Control
without erasing the set speed memory. Rotating the end
of the multifunction lever to the “O” position or turning
the ignition switch OFF erases the set speed memory.
3
94 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
• If the lever is continually help up, the set speed will
continue to increase until the lever is released, then the
To resume a previously set speed, push the RESUME
new set speed will be established.
button and release. Resume can be used at any speed
above 18 mph (30 km/h).
Metric Speed (km/h)
To Resume Speed
To Vary The Speed Setting
To Increase Speed
• Tapping the Speed Control lever up (+) once will result
in a 2 km/h increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap
of the lever results in an increase of 2 km/h.
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can increase speed by tapping the Speed Control lever up (+). • If the lever is continually help up, the set speed will
continue to increase until the lever is released, then the
The speed increment shown is dependant on the speed of
new set speed will be established.
U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
To Decrease Speed
U.S. Speed (mph)
When the Electronic Speed Control is set, you can decrease
• Tapping the Speed Control lever up (+) once will result speed by tapping the Speed Control lever down (-).
in a 1 mph increase in set speed. Each subsequent tap
of the lever results in an increase of 1 mph.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 95
The speed decrement shown is dependant on the speed Metric Speed (km/h)
of U.S. (mph) or Metric (km/h) units:
• Tapping the Speed Control lever down (-) once will
result in a 2 km/h decrease in set speed. Each subseU.S. Speed (mph)
quent tap of the lever results in a decrease of 2 km/h.
• Tapping the Speed Control lever down (-) once will
result in a 1 mph decrease in set speed. Each subse- • If the lever is continually held down, the set speed will
continue to decrease until the lever is released, then
quent tap of the lever results in a decrease of 1 mph.
the new set speed will be established.
• If the lever is continually held down, the set speed will
continue to decrease until the lever is released, then To Accelerate For Passing
the new set speed will be established.
Press the accelerator as you would normally. When the
pedal is released, the vehicle will return to the set speed.
3
96 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
PARKING SENSORS — IF EQUIPPED
Activation/Deactivation
They are located in the rear bumper and their function is The sensors are automatically activated when reverse
to detect the presence of any obstacles near the rear part gear is engaged. As the obstacle behind the car gets
of the car; they consequently inform the driver, through closer, the acoustic signal becomes more frequent.
an intermittent acoustic signal.
Acoustic Signal
When reverse gear is engaged and there is an obstacle
behind the vehicle, an acoustic signal is emitted which
varies according to the distance of the bumper from the
obstacle.
The frequency of the acoustic signal:
• Increases as the distance between car and obstacle decreases, culminating in a continuous acoustic signal when
the distance is less than approximately 12 in (30 cm).
Parking Sensors
• Decreases if the distance from the obstacle increases,
until the signal ceases entirely.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 97
• Remains constant if the distance between car and
obstacle remains unchanged; if this situation concerns
the side sensors, the signal will stop after approximately 3 seconds to avoid, for example, indications in
the event of manoeuvres along a wall.
3
If several obstacles are detected by the sensors, only the
nearest one is considered.
Indications On Display — If Equipped
When the sensors are activated, the screen appears on the
display.
Parking Sensors Screen
Obstacle presence and distance information is therefore
provided both by the acoustic signal and the instrument
panel display.
The system indicates a detected obstacle by displaying an
arc in one or more positions according to the distance of
the obstacle and its position in relation to the car.
98 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
If an obstacle is detected in the rear central area, the
display shows all the arcs in the rear central area, up to
the one that corresponds to the position of the obstacle
itself.
Fault Indication
Parking sensor failures, if any, will be indicated when
warnreverse is engaged by the switching on of the
ing light on the instrument panel together with the
The signal is similar for obstacles in the rear left or right message on the display.
area.
General Warnings
The arc that corresponds to the position of the obstacle
When parking, take the utmost care over obstacles that
will flash.
may be above or under the sensor.
The color on the display depends on the distance from
Under certain circumstances, objects close to the vehicle
and position of the obstacle.
are not detected by the system and could therefore cause
The car is close to the obstacle when the display shows a damage to the car or be damaged themselves.
single constant arc and emits a continuous sound.
Some conditions may influence the performance of the
If there are several obstacles, the closest one is indicated. parking sensors:
• The presence of ice, snow, mud or multiple layers of
paint on the sensor surface may cause reduced sensitivity of the sensor itself and therefore reduce the
system performance.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 99
• Mechanical interference (e.g washing the car, rain, NOTE: The sensor must be free from mud, dirt snow or ice
strong wind, hail) may cause the sensor to detect a in order for the system to operate correctly. Be careful not to
non-existent obstacle (“echo interference”).
scratch or damage the sensors while cleaning them. Avoid
using dry, rough or hard cloths. The sensors must be washed
• The presence of ultrasonic systems (e.g. pneumatic
using clean water, with the addition of car shampoo if
brake systems of trucks or pneumatic drills) near the
necessary. When using special washing equipment such as
car could alter the signals sent by the sensor.
high pressure jets or steam cleaning, clean the sensors very
• The variation in sensor position, caused by variation in quickly keeping the jet more than 4 in (10 cm) away. Also, do
ride (due to suspension component wear), changing not apply stickers to the sensors.
tires, overloaded car, or tuning that lowers the car, for
example, may affect parking sensor system perforCAUTION!
mance.
• The Parking Sensor system is only a parking aid
and it is unable to recognize every obstacle, including small obstacles. Parking curbs might be temporarily detected or not detected at all. Obstacles
located above or below the sensors will not be
detected when they are in close proximity
(Continued)
3
100 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
• The vehicle must be driven slowly when using the
Parking Sensor system in order to be able to stop in
time when an obstacle is detected. It is recommended that the driver looks over his/her shoulder
when using the Parking Sensor system.
POWER OUTLETS
Your vehicle is equipped with a 12 Volt (13 Amp) power
outlet that can be used to power cellular phones, small
electronics and other low powered electrical accessories.
WARNING!
Drivers must be careful when backing up even when
using the Parking Sensor system. Always check carefully behind your vehicle, and be sure to check for
pedestrians, animals, other vehicles, obstructions, or
blind spots before backing up. You are responsible
for the safety of your surroundings and must continue to pay attention while backing up. Failure to do
so can result in serious injury or death.
Front Power Outlet
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 101
The power outlet is located on the central tunnel, between the two cup holders. It only operates with the
ignition key at MAR-ON.
Power Outlet Fuse Location
WARNING!
To avoid serious injury or death:
• Only devices designed for use in this type of outlet
should be inserted into any 12 Volt outlet.
• Do not touch with wet hands.
• Close the lid when not in use and while driving the
vehicle.
• If this outlet is mishandled, it may cause an electric
shock and failure.
3
102 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
• Many accessories that can be plugged in draw
power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not in
use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough, the vehicle’s battery will
discharge sufficiently to degrade battery life and/or
prevent the engine from starting.
• Accessories that draw higher power (i.e., coolers,
vacuum cleaners, lights, etc.) will degrade the battery even more quickly. Only use these intermittently and with greater caution.
• After the use of high power draw accessories, or
long periods of the vehicle not being started (with
accessories still plugged in), the vehicle must be
driven a sufficient length of time to allow the
generator to recharge the vehicle’s battery.
• Do not exceed the maximum power of 180 Watts (15
Amps) at 12 Volts. If the 180 Watts (15 Amps) power
rating is exceeded, the fuse protecting the system
will need to be replaced.
• Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs
only. Do not insert any other object in the power
outlets as this will damage the outlet and blow the
fuse. Improper use of the power outlet can cause
damage not covered by your New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 103
CIGAR LIGHTER AND ASH RECEIVER — IF
EQUIPPED
NOTE:
• Always check that the cigar lighter is switched off.
The cigar lighter and ash receiver are located on the central
tunnel. To activate the cigar lighter, press the button down. • Do not connect devices with power higher than 180 W
to the socket.
After a few seconds the button automatically returns to its
initial position, and the cigar lighter is ready for use.
• Do not damage the socket by using unsuitable adaptors.
Cigar Lighter/Ashtray — If Equipped
3
104 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
CUPHOLDER
STORAGE
A cupholder is located in the rear of the center console.
Seatback Storage
Located in the back of both the driver and passenger
front seats are pockets that can be used for storage.
Center Console Cupholder
Drivers Side Seatback Storage
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 105
Console Features
There is a cargo pouch storage area located between the
driver and passengers seat (If Equipped).
Rear Compartment Storage
CAUTION!
• To prevent possible damage, do not slam the decklid to close it. Use a firm downward push at the
center of the decklid to ensure the decklid latch is
fully engaged.
• During normal car operation, the luggage compartment (located rear of the engine) can reach temperatures above 149 degrees. Do not transport objects in the luggage compartment that may be
damaged at such temperatures. Do not place aerosol cans in the luggage compartment.
Cargo Pouch Storage Location
3
106 UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE
Your vehicle is equipped with a open storage area located
under the decklid.
WARNING!
Do not allow children to have access to rear storage
compartment. Always close the hood when your
vehicle is unattended. Once in the rear storage compartment, young children may not be able to escape.
If trapped in the rear compartment, children can die
from suffocation or heat stroke.
Decklid Emergency Release
As a security measure, an internal decklid emergency
release lever is built into the rear compartment storage
latching mechanism. In a event of a person trapped
inside the storage compartment, the decklid can be
simply opened by pulling on the phosphorescent handle
attached to the decklid latching mechanism.
UNDERSTANDING THE FEATURES OF YOUR VEHICLE 107
WARNING! (Continued)
Rear Compartment Light
WARNING!
• The maximum load limit for the luggage compartment (located rear of the engine), in addition to the
kits provided, is 33 lbs. (15kg). Do not exceed the
(Continued)
maximum permitted load in the luggage compartment. When accessing the rear luggage compartment, do not come into contact with engine, or
other components, that may be hot and could burn
you if touched.
• Access the luggage compartment only with the
vehicle stationary. Before exiting a vehicle, you
should always shift the vehicle into PARK, remove
the key from the ignition, and apply the parking
brake. Never leave the key fob in the vehicle or in
a location accessible to children.
• The decklid may drop suddenly, causing serious
injury, if the supporting rod is not positioned
correctly.
• The decklid must always be closed properly, and
the lock engaged, while the vehicle is in motions.
3
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
CONTENTS
䡵 INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES . . . . . . . . . .110
▫ Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
▫ Values Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
䡵 INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS . . . . .112 䡵 RADIO SYSTEM. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
䡵 ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER 䡵 RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
(EVIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
䡵 HEATING AND VENTILATION . . . . . . . . . .
Setup Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127
▫ Manual Climate Controls With A/C . . . . . .
▫ Change Engine Oil Indicator System . . . . . . . .137
. .142
. .142
. .143
. .143
4
110 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL FEATURES
1
2
3
4
5
—
—
—
—
—
Climate Control Air Outlets
Exterior Light Lever
Instrument Cluster
Washer/Wiper Lever
Passenger Air Bag
6
7
8
9
—
—
—
—
Switch Bank (A/C/Door Lock Switch/Door Mirror Demisting)
Climate Controls
Driver Air Bag
EVIC Control Buttons
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 111
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
4
112 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
1. Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light — If Equipped overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), the vehicle’s handling and stopping ability.
should be checked monthly when cold and
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended
tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to
by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle
maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has
placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle
not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS
has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the
low tire pressure telltale.
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not
tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator is
equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When the
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for
one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. approximately one minute and then remain continuously
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illumi- illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsenates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as quent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER DESCRIPTIONS
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 113
as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety
WARNING! (Continued)
of reasons, including the installation of replacement or
alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the sensor damage. Do not use tire sealant from a can or
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the balance beads if your vehicle is equipped with a
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or more TPMS, as damage to the sensors may result.
tires or wheels on your vehicle, to ensure that the
2. Turn Signal Indicators
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS
The arrows will flash in unison with the exteto continue to function properly.
rior turn signal, when using the turn signal
lever.
WARNING!
The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
warning have been established for the tire size
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system operation or sensor damage may result when using replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
(Continued)
3. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) OFF Indicator
Light
This light indicates the Electronic Stability Control (ESC) is off.
4
114 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
4. Electronic Speed Control Set Indicator Light — If NOTE: Driving with a hot engine cooling system could
Equipped
damage your vehicle. The digital warning light may
switch on (together with a message on the display) to
This light will turn on when the electronic
indicate that the coolant temperature is too high; in this
speed control is set.
case, stop the engine and contact a dedicated authorized
dealership.
5. Temperature Gauge
The temperature gauge shows engine coolant temperature. Any reading within the normal range indicates that
the engine cooling system is operating satisfactorily.
The digital gauge will likely indicate a higher temperature when driving in hot weather, or up mountain
grades. It should not be allowed to exceed the upper
limits of the normal operating range.
WARNING!
A hot engine cooling system is dangerous. You or
others could be badly burned by steam or boiling
coolant. You may want to call an authorized dealer
for service if your vehicle overheats. If you decide to
look under the hood yourself, see “Maintaining Your
Vehicle.” Follow the warnings under the Cooling
System Pressure Cap paragraph.
6. Time Display
This area of the cluster displays the time.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 115
7. Tachometer
Do not travel with the fuel tank almost empty; any gaps
in fuel delivery could damage the catalytic converter.
This gauge measures engine revolutions per minute
(RPM x 1000). Before the pointer reaches the red area, 11. Park/Headlight ON Indicator
ease up on the accelerator to prevent engine damage.
This indicator will illuminate when the park
8. Transmission Gear Status
lights or headlights are turned on.
4
This area of the cluster displays the current gear selected.
9. Outside Temperature
12. High Beam Indicator
This area of the cluster displays the outside temperature
in degrees Fahrenheit or degrees Celsius.
This indicator shows that the high beam headlights are on. Push the multifunction lever forward to switch the headlights to high beam, and pull
toward yourself (normal position) to return to low beam.
10. Fuel Gauge
The digital display shows the amount of fuel in the tank. 13. Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
The switching on of the digital warning light indicates
The Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) is part of
that 1 – 1.3 gallons of fuel are left in the tank; in this
an onboard diagnostic system, called OBD II, that
situation, refuel as soon as possible.
monitors engine and automatic transmission control systems. The light will illuminate when the key is in
the ON/RUN position, before engine start. If the bulb
116 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
does not come on when turning the key from OFF to
ON/RUN, have the condition checked promptly.
WARNING!
Certain conditions, such as smart fuel door left open,
poor fuel quality, etc., may illuminate the MIL after
engine start. The vehicle should be serviced if the light
stays on through several of your typical driving cycles. In
most situations, the vehicle will drive normally and will
not require towing.
A malfunctioning catalytic converter, as referenced
above, can reach higher temperatures than in normal
operating conditions. This can cause a fire if you
drive slowly or park over flammable substances such
as dry plants, wood, cardboard, etc. This could result
in death or serious injury to the driver, occupants or
others.
CAUTION!
Prolonged driving with the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) on could cause damage to the engine
control system. It also could affect fuel economy and
driveability. If the MIL is flashing, severe catalytic
converter damage and power loss will soon occur.
Immediate service is required.
14. Seat Belt Reminder Light
Seat Belt Reminder Light will turn on and remain
on until the driver seat belt is buckled. If the
driver seat belt is unbuckled once the vehicle
speed is over 12.5 mph (20 km/h) or when travelling at a
speed from 6 to 12.5 mph (10 to 20 km/h) for few
seconds, the Seat Belt Reminder Light and sounding an
intermittent chime. Once the sequence starts, it will
continue for the entire duration or until the driver’s seat
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 117
belt is buckled. After the sequence completes, the Seat 16. Passenger Air Bag Warning Light
Belt Reminder Light remains illuminated until the drivThis light should come and remain on for four
er’s seat belt is buckled. The driver should instruct all
to eight seconds as a bulb check when the
other occupants to buckle their seat belts. Refer to
ignition is first turned to the START or ON/
“Occupant Restraints” in “Things To Know Before StartRUN position. If the light stays on, or comes on
ing Your Vehicle” for further information.
while driving it may indicate a problem with a passenger
15. Air Bag Warning Light
air bag system, if the light flickers it may indicate an air
bag warning bag failure. Have an authorized dealer
This light will turn on for four to eight seconds
service the air bag system immediately.
as a bulb check when the ignition switch is first
turned to ON/RUN. If the light is either not on 17. Oil Pressure Warning Light
during starting, stays on, or turns on while
This telltale indicates low engine oil pressure. If
driving, have the system inspected at an authorized
the light turns on while driving, stop the vehicle and shut
dealer as soon as possible. Refer to “Occupant Restraints”
off the engine as soon as possible. A chime will sound
in “Things To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for
when this light turns on.
further information.
Do not operate the vehicle until the cause is corrected.
This light does not show how much oil is in the engine.
The engine oil level must be checked under the hood.
4
118 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
18. Fuel Door Reminder
placed in the 1st position. The light should turn off.
The arrow in this symbol is a reminder that the If the light remains lit with the engine running, your
Fuel Filler Door is located on the right side of vehicle will usually be drivable. However, see an authorized dealer for service as soon as possible. If the light is
the vehicle.
flashing when the engine is running, immediate service is
19. Trip Odometer
required. You may experience reduced performance, an
This area of the cluster displays the total distance trav- elevated/rough idle or engine stall and your vehicle may
require towing.
eled since the last Trip reset.
20. Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) Light
21. Speedometer
This light informs you of a problem with the
Electronic Throttle Control (ETC) system. The
light will come on when the ignition is first
turned ON and remain on briefly as a bulb
check. If the light does not come on during starting, have
the system checked by an authorized dealer.
Indicates vehicle speed.
22. “Alfa DNA” Driving Mode Indicator
This area of the cluster displays which driving mode the
vehicle is currently in. A letter (d, n, or a) corresponding
to the active driving mode (dynamic or race, natural, all
weather) and a dedicated message is shown on the
If a problem is detected, the light will come on while the
display.
engine is running. Cycle the ignition key when the
vehicle has completely stopped and the gear selector is
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 119
23. Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) Dis- NOTE: The “Scheduled Servicing Plan” includes car
play
maintenance at fixed intervals, refer to the ⬙Maintenance⬙
chapter. This message is displayed automatically along
The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) feawith the warning light when the key is turned to
tures a driver-interactive display that is located in the
MAR-ON - 1242 miles (2,000 km) before these deadlines
instrument cluster. For further information, refer to
and reappears every 124 miles (200 km). Below 124 miles
“Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)” in “Un(200 km) servicing indications are more frequent. The
derstanding Your Instrument Panel.”
indication will appear in miles or kilometers according to
EVIC Service Item Display
the ⬙Unit Of Measurement⬙ settings. When the next
• Service Warning light – If Equipped
scheduled service is approaching and the key is turned to
MAR-ON, the word Service will appear on the display,
followed by the number of miles or kilometers left.
Contact a dedicated Alfa Romeo Dealership. The operations in the “Scheduled Servicing Plan” will be performed and the message will be reset.
4
120 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
24. Odometer Display
25. Transmission Fault Indicator
This light will illuminate (together with a message in the EVIC and a buzzer) to indicate a
transmission fault. Contact your authorized
U.S. Federal regulations require that upon transfer of
dealer if the message remains after restarting
vehicle ownership, the seller certify to the purchaser the
the
engine.
correct mileage that the vehicle has been driven. If your
odometer needs to be repaired or serviced, the repair 26. Door Mirror Defrost Indicator
technician should leave the odometer reading the same
This indicator will illuminate when the Door
as it was before the repair or service. If s/he cannot do so,
Mirror Defrost button on the instrument panel
then the odometer must be set at zero, and a sticker must
is pushed to the ON position.
be placed in the door jamb stating what the mileage was
before the repair or service. It is a good idea for you to 27. Electronic Stability Control (ESC) Activation/
make a record of the odometer reading before the repair/ Malfunction Indicator Light
service, so that you can be sure that it is properly reset, or
If the “ESC Activation/Malfunction Indicator
that the door jamb sticker is accurate if the odometer
Light” comes on continuously with the engine
must be reset at zero.
running, a malfunction has been detected in
the ESC system. If this light remains on after
several ignition cycles, and the vehicle has been driven
The odometer display shows the total distance the vehicle has been driven.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 121
several miles (kilometers) at speeds greater than 30 mph indicate that the parking brake is applied, that the brake
(48 km/h), see your authorized dealer as soon as possible fluid level is low, or that there is a problem with the
to have the problem diagnosed and corrected.
anti-lock brake system reservoir.
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been
disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark on the
• Each time the ignition is turned to ON/RUN, the
master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake
ESC system will be ON, even if it was turned off
hydraulic system malfunction or that a problem with the
previously.
Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock Brake
• The ESC system will make buzzing or clicking System (ABS) / Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system.
sounds when it is active. This is normal; the sounds In this case, the light will remain on until the condition
will stop when ESC becomes inactive following the has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake
maneuver that caused the ESC activation.
booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake
and a brake pedal pulsation may be felt during each stop.
28. Brake Warning Light — If Equipped
NOTE:
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacThis light monitors various brake functions,
ity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
including brake fluid level and parking brake
system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is
application. If the brake light turns on it may
indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the reservoir has dropped
below a specified level.
4
122 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
Vehicles equipped with the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS), are also equipped with Electronic Brake Force
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp
Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD failure, the
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level condiBrake Warning Light will turn on along with the ABS
tions. The vehicle should have service performed, and
Light. Immediate repair to the ABS system is required.
the brake fluid level checked.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necesturning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the
sary.
ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
WARNING!
unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is
Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light
dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed. inspected by an authorized dealer.
It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
a collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 123
29. Brake Warning Light — If Equipped
The dual brake system provides a reserve braking capacity in the event of a failure to a portion of the hydraulic
system. A leak in either half of the dual brake system is
indicated by the Brake Warning Light, which will turn on
when the brake fluid level in the reservoir has dropped
below a specified level.
This light monitors various brake functions, including brake fluid level and parking brake application. If the brake light turns on it may indicate that
the parking brake is applied, that the brake fluid level is
low, or that there is a problem with the anti-lock brake
The light will remain on until the cause is corrected.
system reservoir.
If the light remains on when the parking brake has been
disengaged, and the fluid level is at the full mark on the
master cylinder reservoir, it indicates a possible brake
hydraulic system malfunction or that a problem with the
Brake Booster has been detected by the Anti-Lock Brake
System (ABS) / Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system.
In this case, the light will remain on until the condition
has been corrected. If the problem is related to the brake
booster, the ABS pump will run when applying the brake
and a brake pedal pulsation may be felt during each stop.
NOTE: The light may flash momentarily during sharp
cornering maneuvers, which change fluid level conditions. The vehicle should have service performed, and
the brake fluid level checked.
If brake failure is indicated, immediate repair is necessary.
4
124 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
WARNING!
Driving a vehicle with the red brake light on is
dangerous. Part of the brake system may have failed.
It will take longer to stop the vehicle. You could have
a collision. Have the vehicle checked immediately.
Vehicles equipped with the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS), are also equipped with Electronic Brake Force
Distribution (EBD). In the event of an EBD failure, the
Brake Warning Light will turn on along with the ABS
Light. Immediate repair to the ABS system is required.
Operation of the Brake Warning Light can be checked by
turning the ignition switch from the OFF position to the
ON/RUN position. The light should illuminate for approximately two seconds. The light should then turn off
unless the parking brake is applied or a brake fault is
detected. If the light does not illuminate, have the light
inspected by an authorized dealer.
The light also will turn on when the parking brake is
applied with the ignition switch in the ON/RUN position.
NOTE: This light shows only that the parking brake is
applied. It does not show the degree of brake application.
30. Anti-Lock Brake (ABS) Light
This light monitors the Anti-Lock Brake System
(ABS). The light will turn on when the ignition
switch is turned to the ON/RUN position and
may stay on for as long as four seconds.
If the ABS light remains on or turns on while driving, it
indicates that the Anti-Lock portion of the brake system
is not functioning and that service is required. However,
the conventional brake system will continue to operate
normally if the BRAKE warning light is not on.
If the ABS light is on, the brake system should be serviced
as soon as possible to restore the benefits of Anti-Lock
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 125
brakes. If the ABS light does not turn on when the The Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC) feaignition switch is turned to the ON/RUN position, have tures a driver-interactive display that is located in the
the light inspected by an authorized dealer.
instrument cluster.
ELECTRONIC VEHICLE INFORMATION CENTER
(EVIC)
The EVIC consists of the following:
• Digital Speedometer
• Vehicle Info
• Fuel Economy Info
• Trip Info
• Screen Setup
• Vehicle Settings
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
4
126 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
The system allows the driver to select information by • UP Arrow Button
pushing the following buttons mounted on the instruPush and release the UP arrow button to scroll
ment panel to the left of the steering column:
upward through the main menu and submenus or to increase the displayed value. Outside of the menu, the UP arrow will adjust the
brightness of the instrument panel.
• DOWN Arrow Button
Push and release the DOWN arrow button to
scroll downward through the main menu and
sub-menus or to decrease the displayed value.
Outside of the menu, the DOWN arrow will
adjust the brightness of the instrument panel.
EVIC Control Buttons
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 127
• SET/BACK Arrow Button
• Trip B/Data
Push and release the SET/BACK arrow button to access/ • Set Time
select the information screens or sub-menu screens of a
• Set Date
main menu item. Push and hold the SET/BACK arrow
button to return to the main menu from an info screen or • Autoclose
sub-menu item.
• Units
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
• Language
Setup Menu
• Buzzer Volume
The menu comprises a series of functions arranged in a
cycle. Push the UP
and DOWN
buttons to access • Service
the different options and settings (setup).
• Daylights (D.R.L.) – If Equipped
The setup menu can be activated by pushing the SET/
BACK button. Single push on the UP
or DOWN • Exit Menu
buttons will scroll through the setup menu options.
The menu includes the following functions:
• Menu
• Speed Buzzer
4
128 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu Without 3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to select the disSubmenu
played submenu option and to open the relevant setup
menu.
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to select the main
or DOWN
button (by a single
menu option to set.
4. Push the UP
push) to select the new setting for this submenu
or DOWN
button (by a single
2. Push the UP
option.
push) to select the new setting.
5. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to store the new
3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to store the new
setting and go back to the previously selected subsetting and go back to the main menu option previmenu option.
ously selected.
Selecting An Option Of The Main Menu With Sub- 6. Push and hold the SET/BACK button to return to the
main menu (short hold) or the main screen (longer
menu
hold).
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to display the first
Speed Buzzer (Speed Limit)
submenu option.
With this function, it is possible to set the car speed limit
or DOWN
button (by a single
2. Push the UP
(mph or km/h) to immediately alert the driver when the
push) to scroll through all the submenu options.
set limit is exceeded.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 129
• Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. The display will
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
show the message (Speed Buzzer).
screen without storing the settings.
or DOWN
button to
2. Push and release the UP
To cancel the setting, proceed as follows:
select speed limit activation (On) or deactivation
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. “On” will display.
(Off).
To set the speed limit, proceed as follows:
3. When the function is activated (On), briefly push the 2. Push and release the DOWN
button. “Off” will
SET/BACK button to display the previously set speed.
display.
or DOWN
buttons selects the 3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
Pushing the UP
speed limit. Push SET/BACK to confirm selection.
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
NOTE: The setting can be increased or decreased by
screen without storing the settings.
5 mph or km/h each time the UP/DOWN button is
pushed for speed settings above 20 mph (32 km/h). To Trip B Activation
increase or decrease the set speed rapidly, push and hold
the UP/DOWN button. Save the setting by briefly push- Through this option, it is possible to activate (On) or
ing the button when you approach the required setting. deactivate (Off) the Trip B (partial trip) display.
For further information see “Trip Computer.”
4
130 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
For activation / deactivation, proceed as follows:
Proceed as follows:
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. “On” or “Off” 1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. The display will
show the two sub-menu items “Time” and “Mode.”
will display in the EVIC (according to previous setting).
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button to
or DOWN
button to
navigate the two sub-menu items.
2. Push and release the UP
select the setting and once selected a beep will
3. Select the required option and then prush the SET/
occur to signal the setting is saved.
BACK button.
3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
4. When accessing the “Time” sub-menu item, briefly
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
push the SET/BACK button and “hours” will flash on
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
the display.
screen without storing the settings.
or DOWN
button for
5. Push and release the UP
Set Time
setting.
This function may be used to set the clock through two
6. Briefly push the SET/BACK button and “minutes”
sub-menu items: “Time” and “Mode.”
will flash on the display.
7. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 131
sub-menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK
• The setting will increase or decrease by one unit each button (approximately one second) to go back to the
or DOWN
button is pushed. main screen without storing the settings.
time the UP
Push and hold the button to increase/decrease the Set Date
setting rapidly. Save the setting by briefly pushing
This function may be used to set the date (day - month the button when you approach the required setyear).
ting.
• Briefly push the SET/BACK button to return to the To change the date proceed as follows:
NOTE:
“Time” sub-function.
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button and “year” will
flash on the display.
• When accessing the “Mode” submenu, briefly push
the SET/BACK button. The previously set display 2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
format will flash on the display.
setting.
or DOWN
button to 3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button and “month” will
• Push and release the UP
select “24h” or “12h.”
flash on the display.
When you have selected the required settings, briefly 4. Push and release the UP
push the SET/BACK button to go back to the Time, Mode
setting.
or DOWN
button for
4
132 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
5. Briefly push the SET/BACK button and “day” will Autoclose
flash on the display.
With this function active, the doors will automatically
or DOWN
button for lock at when the vehicle’s speed exceeds 12 mph
6. Push and release the UP
(20 km/h).
setting.
NOTE: The setting will increase or decrease by one unit To change the setting proceed as follows:
or DOWN
button is pushed.
each time the UP
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button “On” or “Off” will
Push and hold the UP
or DOWN
button to
flash on the display (according to the previous setincrease/decrease the setting rapidly. Save the setting
ting).
by briefly pushing the button when you approach the
or DOWN
button for
2. Push and release the UP
required setting.
setting.
• Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button 3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
screen without storing the settings.
screen without storing the settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 133
5. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
setting.
This function may be used to set the measurement unit in
three submenus: “Distance,” “Temperature” and “Fuel 6. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to return to the
Economy.”
sub-menu.
Units (Set Units)
To set the required unit, proceed as follows:
1.
2.
3.
4.
7. When accessing the “Fuel Economy” submenu, briefly
push the SET/BACK button. Either “mpg,” “km/l ” or
Briefly push the SET/BACK button to display the
“l/100km” will appear on the display (according to
three sub-menus.
the previous setting).
or DOWN
button to
Push and release the UP
If the distance unit set is “mi,” the fuel economy unit will
navigate the three sub-menus.
be displayed in “mpg.”
Select the required sub-menu and then briefly push
If the distance unit set is “km,” the fuel economy unit will
the SET/BACK button.
be displayed in either km/l or l/100km.
When accessing the “Distance” submenu: briefly push
or DOWN
button for
the SET/BACK button. Either “mi” or “km” will 1. Push and release the UP
setting.
appear on the display (according to the previous
setting).
2. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to return to the
sub-menu.
4
134 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
3. When accessing the “Temperature” submenu: briefly To set the required language, proceed as follows:
push the SET/BACK button. Either “°F” or “°C” will
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. The previously
appear on the display (according to the previous
set “language” will flash on the display.
setting).
2. Push and release the UP
or DOWN
button for
or DOWN
button for
4. Push and release the UP
setting.
setting.
3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
5. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to return to the
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
sub-menu.
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
When you have made the required settings, briefly push
screen without storing the settings.
the SET/BACK button to go back to the sub-menu screen,
Buzzer Volume (Adjusting The Failure/Warning
or push and hold the SET/BACK button (approximately
Buzzer Volume)
one second) to go back to the main screen without storing
With this function the volume of the buzzer accompanythe settings.
ing any failure/warning indication can be adjusted to
Language (Selecting The Language)
one of eight volume levels.
The messages can be displayed in the following languages: Italian, English (USA), German, Portuguese,
Spanish, French, Chinese, Russian, and Mexican.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 135
To adjust the volume proceed as follows:
Service (Scheduled Servicing) — If Equipped
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. The previously
set volume “level” will flash on the display.
2. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
With this function it is possible to view information on mileage intervals for servicing.
button for
3. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen, or push and hold the SET/BACK button
(approximately one second) to go back to the main
screen without storing the settings.
To obtain this information, proceed as follows:
Push the SET/BACK button briefly. The display shows
the service interval in miles (mi) or kilometers (km)
according to the previous setting (see the ⬙Unit Of
Measurement⬙ paragraph).
Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen or hold the button down to go back to the
standard screen.
4
136 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
NOTE: The “Scheduled Servicing Plan” includes car
maintenance at fixed intervals, refer to the ⬙Maintenance⬙
chapter. This message is displayed automatically along
warning light when the key is turned to
with the
MAR-ON - 1242 miles (2,000 km) before these deadlines and reappears every 124 miles (200 km). Below
124 miles (200 km) servicing indications are more
frequent. The indication will appear in miles or kilometers according to the ⬙Unit Of Measurement⬙ settings. When the next scheduled service is approaching
and the key is turned to MAR-ON, the word Service
will appear on the display, followed by the number of
miles or kilometers left. Contact a dedicated Alfa
Romeo Dealership. The operations in the “Scheduled
Servicing Plan” will be performed and the message
reset.
will be
Day Lights — If Equipped
This function may be used to activate / deactivate the
Daytime Running Lamps.
Proceed as follows to switch this function on or off:
1. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to display the
three submenus.
2. Briefly push the SET/BACK button. “On” or “Off”
will flash on the display (according to previous setting).
3. Push and release the UP
setting.
or DOWN
button for
4. Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
menu screen, or push and hold the button (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen
without storing the settings.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 137
Exit Menu
Change Engine Oil Indicator System
This function closes the initial menu screen.
Your vehicle is equipped with an engine oil
Briefly push the SET/BACK button to go back to the
change indicator system. The “Change Engine Oil” mesmain screen.
sage will flash in the EVIC display for approximately 10
button to return to the first seconds and the Oil Pressure Warning Light will illumiPush and release the
menu option (Speed Buzzer).
nate. The “Change Engine Oil” message in the EVIC and
the Oil Pressure Warning Light will turn off after apPush and releasethe
button to return to the last
proximately 10 seconds.
menu option (Daylights).
NOTE: The reset of the Oil Change message must be
performed by an authorized dealer.
Trip Computer
The Trip Computer is located in the instrument cluster. It
features a driver-interactive display (displays information such as trip information, range, fuel consumption,
average speed, and travel time).
4
138 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
• A long button push resets the system and then starts a
new trip.
Trip Button
The TRIP button, located on the right steering column
stalk, can be used to display and to reset the trip values. Trip Functions
Both trip functions are resettable (reset — start of new
trip).
“Trip A” can be used to display the figures relating to:
• Range
• Average Fuel Consumption
• Travel Distance
• Current Fuel Consumption
• Average speed
Trip Button
• A short button push displays the different values.
• Travel time
“Trip B” can be used to display the figures relating to:
• Average Fuel Consumption
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 139
• Travel Distance
• Average speed
• Disconnecting/Reconnecting the battery resets the
system.
NOTE: If the reset operation occurs in the presence of
the screens concerning Trip A or Trip B, only the inforNOTE: “Trip B” functions may be excluded (see “Trip mation associated with Trip A or Trip B functions will be
B Data”). “Range” and “Instantaneous consumption” reset.
cannot be reset.
Start Of Trip Procedure
New Trip
With the ignition on, push and hold the TRIP button for
To reset:
over one second to reset.
• Travel time
• Push and hold the TRIP button to reset the system Exit Trip
manually.
To exit the Trip function, wait until all the values have
• When the “Trip distance” reaches 9999.9 miles or been displayed or hold the MENU button for longer than
kilometers or when the “Travel time” reaches 999.59 one second.
(999 hours and 59 minutes), the system is reset auto- Briefly push and release the MENU button to go back to
matically.
the menu screen or push and hold the MENU (approximately one second) to go back to the main screen without
storing settings.
4
140 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Values Displayed
Indications On Display
Each time a value is selected, the following information is
shown in the EVIC:
• “Trip A” or “Trip B” location(s)
• Name, value and unit of measure of the selected value
(e.g. ⬙Range 520 mi⬙).
After a few seconds, the name of the selected value is
replaced by the corresponding icon.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 141
Range
Travel Distance
This indicates the distance which may be traveled with This value shows the distance covered since the last reset.
the fuel remaining in the tank, assuming that driving
Current Fuel Consumption
conditions will not change. The message “----” will
This indicates the fuel consumption. The value is conappear on the display in the following cases:
stantly updated. The message “----” will appear on the
• Distance less than 30 miles (or 50 km).
display if the car is parked with the engine running.
• The vehicle is parked for a long time with the engine
Average Speed
running.
This value shows the vehicle’s average speed as a funcNOTE: The range depends on several factors: driving
tion of the overall time elapsed since the last reset.
style, type of route (freeway, residential, mountain roads,
etc.), conditions of use of the car (load, tire pressure, etc.). Travel Time
Trip planning must take into account the above notes.
This value shows the time elapsed since the last reset.
Average Fuel Consumption
Tire Pressure Values
This value shows the approximate average consumption
This screen will display OK at each Tire Pressure Monisince the last reset.
toring sensor. Refer to “Tire Pressure Monitoring System”
in “Starting And Operating.”
4
142 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
RADIO SYSTEM
The radio system consists of:
• Supply cables for radio, speakers and aerial;
• Radio;
• Aerial on front bumper;
by relocating the mobile phone antenna. This condition is
not harmful to the radio. If your radio performance does
not satisfactorily “clear” by the repositioning of the
antenna, it is recommended that the radio volume be
turned down or off during mobile phone operation.
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
• No. 2 tweeter speakers with 38 mm diameter and No.
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
2 mid-woofer speakers with 130 mm diameter, fitted
following conditions:
on the doors.
• Changes or modifications not expressly approved by
For further information on radio functions and use, refer
the party responsible for compliance could void the
to the dedicated Supplement attached to the On-Board
user’s authority to operate the equipment.
Documentation.
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
RADIO OPERATION AND MOBILE PHONES
• This device must accept any interference received,
Under certain conditions, the mobile phone being on in
including interference that may cause undesired opyour vehicle can cause erratic or noisy performance from
eration.
your radio. This condition may be lessened or eliminated
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 143
HEATING AND VENTILATION
1. A/C Button
Manual Climate Controls With A/C
Press this button to engage the Air Conditioning. A light
will illuminate when the Air Conditioning system is
engaged.
MAX A/C
For maximum cooling, use the A/C and recirculation
modes at the same time.
ECONOMY MODE
If economy mode is desired, press the A/C switch to turn
OFF the A/C compressor. Then, rotate the temperature
control to the desired temperature.
2. Demist/Defrost Control
Press and release the Demist/Defrost Control button to
turn ON the heated outside mirrors. The Demist/Defrost
The Heating/Ventilation And Air Conditioning Controls feature automatically turns OFF after 20 minutes.
consist of a series of three rotary dials, a movable cursor
and two on/off switches.
Heating/Ventilation And Air Conditioning Controls
4
144 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Mix – Air is directed through the floor, defrost, and side
window demister outlets. This setting works
Rotate this control to change the system between Modes
best in cold or snowy conditions that require
(Panel, Bi-Level, Floor, Mix, Defrost).
extra heat to the windshield. This setting is
Panel – Air is directed through the outlets in the
good for maintaining comfort while reducing
instrument panel. These outlets can be adjusted to moisture on the windshield.
direct airflow.
4. Recirculation Control
Bi-Level – Air is directed through the panel and floor Slide cursor to change the system between recirculation
outlets.
mode and outside air mode. Recirculation can be used
3. Mode Control
when outside conditions such as smoke, odors, dust, or
high humidity are present.
Floor – Air is directed through the floor outlets with a
small amount flowing through the defrost and
side window demister outlets.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 145
speed increases as you move the control clockwise from
• Continuous use of the Recirculation mode may make the “0” (OFF) position. There are four blower speeds.
the inside air stuffy and window fogging may occur. Heating
Extended use of this mode is not recommended.
To heat the passenger compartment, proceed as follows:
• The use of the Recirculation mode in cold or damp
weather could cause windows to fog on the inside, 1. Rotate the Temperature Control to the red section.
because of moisture buildup inside the vehicle. Se- 2. Turn the Blower Control to the desired speed.
lect the outside air position for maximum defogging.
.
3. Turn the Mode Control to
5. Temperature Control
4. Then operate the controls to maintain the desired
Rotate this control to regulate the temperature of the air
comfort conditions.
inside the passenger compartment. Rotating the dial
counterclockwise into the blue area of the scale indicates NOTE:
cooler temperatures, while rotating clockwise into the red • This air distribution allows the passenger compartarea indicates warmer temperatures.
ment to be heated quickly.
6. Blower Control
• When the engine is cold, it takes a few minutes to
NOTE:
Rotate this control to regulate the amount of air forced
through the ventilation system in any mode. The blower
achieve optimum passenger compartment heating.
4
146 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Fast Demisting/Defrosting Of Windshield And
Side Windows
Proceed as follows:
1. Rotate the Temperature Control to the red section.
2. Turn the Blower Control to 4 (maximum fan speed).
3. Turn the Mode Control to
.
4. Move the Recirculation Control to
Window Demisting
In the event of considerable external moisture and/or
rain and/or large differences in temperature inside and
outside the passenger compartment, perform the following preventive window demisting procedure:
1. Move the Recirculation Control to
.
2. Rotate the Temperature Control to the red section.
.
3. Turn the Blower Control to 2 (intermediate fan speed).
After demisting/defrosting, operate the controls as norwith the possibility of
4. Turn the Mode Control to
mal to restore the required comfort conditions.
if window misting does not
moving it to position
occur.
NOTE: The climate control system is very useful for
speeding up and maintaining demisting since it dehumidifies the air. Adjust the controls as described previously and switch on the climate control system by
pressing the A/C button.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 147
NOTE: The internal air recirculation system makes it
possible to reach the required heating or ventilation
To ventilate the passenger compartment properly, proconditions more quickly. Do not use the internal air
ceed as follows:
recirculation function on rainy/cold days to avoid the
1. Fully open the vents and direct them appropriately.
possibility of the windows misting.
2. Rotate the Temperature Control to the blue section.
Climate Control
Ventilation
3. Move the Recirculation Control to
.
4. Turn the Blower Control to the desired speed.
5. Turn the Mode Control to
.
Internal Air Recirculation Activation
Proceed as follows:
1. Rotate the Temperature Control to the blue section.
2. Turn the Blower Control to 1 (1st fan speed). For rapid
cooling, turn Blower Control to 4 (maximum fan speed).
• Move the Recirculation Control to
.
3. Move the Recirculation Control to
It is advisable to switch the internal air recirculation on
while standing in queues or in tunnels to prevent the 4. Turn the Mode Control to .
introduction of polluted air.
5. Press the A/C button.
Do not use the function for a long time, particularly if
there are two people on board, to prevent the windows
from misting.
.
4
148 UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL
Cooling Adjustment
Door Mirror Demisting
Proceed as follows:
1. Move the Recirculation Control to
.
2. Rotate the Temperature Control towards the red section to increase the temperature.
3. Turn the Blower Control counterclockwise to reduce
the fan speed.
Demist/Defrost Button
• Press the
button to activate this function.
• Press the
button again to deactivate the function.
Activation is indicated by the digital warning light on the
display.
UNDERSTANDING YOUR INSTRUMENT PANEL 149
System Maintenance
In winter, the climate control system must be turned on at
least once a month for about 10 minutes. Have the system
inspected at an authorized dealer before the summer.
NOTE: The system uses R-1234yf and R134a coolant
which does not pollute the environment in the event of
accidental leakage. Under no circumstances should you
use R-134a fluid which, in addition to being incompatible
with the system’s components, contributes greatly to the
greenhouse effect.
4
STARTING AND OPERATING
CONTENTS
䡵 STARTING PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 䡵 ALFA DNA SYSTEM (DYNAMIC CAR CONTROL
SYSTEM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
▫ Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
▫ Driving Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
▫ Normal Starting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ System Failure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
▫ Cold Weather Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
▫ Launch Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
▫ If Engine Fails To Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
䡵 DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES . . . . . . . . .169
▫ After Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
▫ Acceleration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
▫ Turbo Charger “Cool Down” . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
▫ Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
䡵 SIX-SPEED ALFA TWIN CLUTCH
TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156 䡵 DRIVING THROUGH WATER . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
▫ Using The Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
▫ Flowing/Rising Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
5
152 STARTING AND OPERATING
▫ Shallow Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .171
▫ Hydraulic Brake Assistant System (HBA) . . . .182
䡵 PARKING BRAKE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
▫ Electronic Q2 System (E-Q2) . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
䡵 BRAKE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174
▫ Ready Alert Brake System (RAB) . . . . . . . . . .183
䡵 ESC (ELECTRONIC STABILITY CONTROL)
SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
䡵 TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
▫ System Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
▫ System Intervention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
▫ Electronic Brake Distribution System (EBD) . . .177
▫ Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . .177
▫ Cornering Brake Control System (CBC) . . . . . .179
▫ Drag Torque Control System (DTC) . . . . . . . .179
▫ AntiSlip Regulation System (ASR) . . . . . . . . .179
▫ Hill Start Assist (HSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .181
▫ Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
▫ Tire Identification Number (TIN). . . . . . . . . . .187
▫ Tire Terminology And Definitions . . . . . . . . . .189
▫ Tire Loading And Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . .190
䡵 TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION . . . . . . . .195
▫ Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
▫ Tire Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
▫ Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation . . . .198
▫ Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
STARTING AND OPERATING 153
▫ Tire Types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .199 䡵 FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.750 Turbo . . . . . . .214
▫ Run Flat Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
▫ Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
▫ Spare Tires — If Equipped . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .201
▫ Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
▫ Tire Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
▫ MMT In Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
▫ Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
▫ Materials Added To Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
▫ Life Of Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
▫ Fuel System Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
▫ Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
▫ Carbon Monoxide Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
䡵 TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES) . . . . . . .207 䡵 ADDING FUEL/SMART FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
䡵 TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS . . . . .208 䡵 TRAILER TOWING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
䡵 TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM
䡵 RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
(TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
MOTORHOME, ETC.) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
▫ Base System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .211
▫ General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
▫ Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle . .221
5
154 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING PROCEDURES
Automatic Transmission
Before starting your vehicle, adjust your seat, adjust both To start the engine press the brake pedal: the system
inside and outside mirrors, and fasten your seat belts.
engages NEUTRAL (N) automatically.
WARNING!
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle (or
in a location accessible to children). A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
After the starting procedure, FIRST (1st) gear or REVERSE (R) can be engaged.
Irrespective of the mode selected (AUTO/MANUAL), to
engage FIRST (1st) gear or REVERSE (R), it is necessary
to press the brake pedal and press the 1 button on the
transmission control panel (or the ⬙+⬙ steering wheel
stalk) to engage FIRST (1st) gear or the R button to
engage REVERSE (R).
When FIRST (1st) gear is engaged, the system sets itself to
AUTO mode.
NEUTRAL (N) can be engaged again by pressing the N
button with the brake pedal pressed.
STARTING AND OPERATING 155
When the 1, N or R buttons are pressed (or ⬙+⬙ steering Cold Weather Operation
wheel stalk is operated) without pressing the brake Your engine is designed to operate at temperatures as
pedal, no gear change request is implemented by the low as 0°F (-18°C).
system.
NOTE: Use of the recommended SAE 5W-40 Synthetic oil
NOTE: REVERSE (R) cannot be engaged by pressing the and adhering to the prescribed oil change intervals is
⬙-⬙ stalk on the steering wheel.
important to prevent engine damage and ensure satisfactory starting in cold conditions.
Normal Starting
NOTE: Normal starting of either a cold or a warm If Engine Fails To Start
engine is obtained without pumping or pressing the
WARNING!
accelerator pedal.
Turn the ignition switch to the AVV/ACC (START)
position and release it when the engine starts. If the
engine fails to start within 10 seconds, turn the ignition
switch to the STOP (OFF/LOCK) position, wait 10 to 15
seconds, then repeat the “Normal Starting” procedure.
Never pour fuel or other flammable liquids into the
throttle body air inlet opening in an attempt to start
the vehicle. This could result in a flash fire causing
serious personal injury.
5
156 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
• Do not attempt to push or tow your vehicle to get it
started. Vehicles equipped with a Alfa Twin Clutch
Transmission cannot be started this way. Unburned
fuel could enter the catalytic converter and once the
engine has started, ignite and damage the converter
and vehicle.
• To prevent damage to the starter, do not continuously crank the engine for more than 15 seconds at
a time. Wait 10 to 15 seconds before trying again.
After Starting
The idle speed is controlled automatically and it will
decrease as the engine warms up.
Turbo Charger “Cool Down”
This vehicle is equipped with an after-run pump to cool
the turbocharger after the engine is shut off. Depending
on the type of driving and the amount of cargo, the pump
will run for up to five minutes after the engine has been
shut off to circulate coolant through the turbocharger.
Although the pump is rubber-mounted for quiet operation, it is normal to hear it running during this time.
SIX-SPEED ALFA TWIN CLUTCH TRANSMISSION
WARNING!
• It is dangerous to shift out of NEUTRAL if the
engine speed is higher than idle speed. If your foot
is not firmly pressing the brake pedal, the vehicle
could accelerate quickly forward or in reverse. You
could lose control of the vehicle and hit someone or
something. Only shift into gear when the engine is
idling normally and your foot is firmly pressing
the brake pedal.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 157
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unintended movement of a vehicle could injure
those in or near the vehicle. As with all vehicles,
you should never exit a vehicle while the engine is
running. Before exiting the vehicle, always apply
the parking brake, shift the transmission into gear,
turn the engine OFF, and remove the ignition key.
• When leaving the vehicle, always remove the ignition key and lock your vehicle.
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle. Allowing children to
be in a vehicle unattended is dangerous for a
number of reasons. A child or others could be
seriously or fatally injured. Children should be
warned not to touch the parking brake, brake pedal
or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the ignition key in or near the vehicle
(or in a location accessible to children). A child
could operate power windows, other controls, or
move the vehicle.
(Continued)
Using The Transmission
This vehicle is equipped with a Six-Speed Alfa Twin
Clutch transmission with steering wheel mounted shift
paddles.
When the ignition is in the OFF position, the transmission
controls (shift paddles on the steering wheel, and gear
selector buttons on the center console) are disabled.
When the key is turned to the ON position, the current
transmission gear will be displayed in the instrument
cluster, along with the ⬙AUTO⬙ indicator. This indicates
the transmission is in Automatic mode.
5
158 STARTING AND OPERATING
MANUAL mode in which the driver must shift gears
manually (using the steering wheel mounted shift
paddles).
Automatic (AUTO) mode, in which the system shifts
between all forward gears automatically.
When the “Race” mode is selected via the DNA selector,
the only allowed transmission operating mode is
MANUAL.
MANUAL Mode
Transmission Gear Selector
Operating Modes
In this operating mode, the driver is responsible for
choosing the best gear to engage, depending on the car
operating conditions. The current gear is displayed in the
instrument cluster.
The transmission has two normal operating modes (except when the “Race” mode is selected on the DNA To activate/deactivate MANUAL mode, press the A/M
switch):
button on the center console when the transmission is in
any forward gear.
STARTING AND OPERATING 159
Use the “+” shift paddle to engage a higher gear, or the AUTO Mode
“–” paddle to engage a lower gear.
In AUTO mode the transmission shifts gears automatiIf a requested gear shift is not allowed (typically, because cally depending on vehicle speed, engine RPM, and
it would cause engine overspeed or lugging), an audible accelerator pedal position.
signal will sound and the transmission will remain in the AUTO is the default operating mode at startup. When in
existing gear.
AUTO mode, ⬙AUTO⬙ appears in the instrument cluster,
The transmission will automatically downshift during adjacent to the current gear display.
closed-throttle decelerations, to prevent engine lugging.
When coming to a stop, the transmission will automatically select FIRST (1st) gear. The driver must manually
upshift the transmission (by tapping the + shift paddle)
as the vehicle accelerates.
To toggle between AUTO and MANUAL modes, press
the A/M button on the center console.
Accelerating From A Stop
FIRST (1st) and REVERSE (R) can only be engaged (at a
stop) by pressing “1” or “R” when the brake pedal is
NOTE: To provide better comfort, the transmission will
pressed.
up-shift to the next available gear if the engine speed
limit is reached. This feature is only available in NATU- To drive, press the brake pedal, and select 1 (One) or R
RAL and ALL WEATHER Modes.
(Reverse) by pressing “1” or “R” using the transmission
gear selector buttons on the center console. Then release
the brake pedal and smoothly press the accelerator pedal.
5
160 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: When starting on a fairly steep incline, it may be Tapping the (+) paddle will upshift the transmission to
the next higher gear, while tapping the (-) paddle will
advisable to engage the parking brake.
downshift to the next lower gear. The current gear is
The vehicle can only be launched (from a stop) in FIRST
displayed in the instrument cluster. If a requested shift
(1st) or REVERSE (R). SECOND (2nd) gear (or higher)
would cause engine lugging or overspeed, that request
cannot be engaged when the vehicle is stationary.
will be ignored.
FIRST (1st) and REVERSE (R) gears can only be engaged
In AUTO mode, tapping a shift paddle will temporarily
at vehicle speeds below 2 mph (3 km/h). At speeds
place the transmission in MANUAL mode, and execute
below 6 mph (10 km/h), attempts to shift from 1st to R
the requested upshift or downshift (if allowable). The
(or R to 1st) will only be allowed if the vehicle speed
transmission will then return to AUTO mode after a brief
drops below the 2 mph (3 km/h) threshold within three
interval. Pressing a shift paddle will only shift the
seconds of the request; otherwise, the transmission will
transmission one gear at a time. Holding a paddle
shift to NEUTRAL (N). The driver should then repeat the
depressed will not command multiple shifts; the paddle
request for 1st or R once the vehicle has come to a stop.
must be pressed multiple times in succession to generate
multiple shifts.
Shift Paddles
In MANUAL mode, the steering wheel mounted shift If the brake pedal is not depressed (and the car is
paddles (labeled + and -) control the transmission shift- stationary for a period of time), the transmission will
automatically engage NEUTRAL (N).
ing.
STARTING AND OPERATING 161
Neutral (N)
Use this range when the vehicle is standing for prolonged
periods with the engine running. Always apply the
parking brake if you must leave the vehicle.
At engine startup, the transmission will automatically
select NEUTRAL (N) and AUTO mode. The brake pedal
must be pressed when starting the engine.
WARNING!
Do not coast in NEUTRAL and never turn off the
ignition to coast down a hill. These are unsafe
practices that limit your response to changing traffic
or road conditions. You might lose control of the
vehicle and have a collision.
With car in motion, to engage a gear from the NEUTRAL
To select NEUTRAL (N) when the vehicle is stationary,
(N) position, press the 1 button on the transmission
turn the ignition key to the MAR-ON position (engine
control panel (it is not necessary to press the brake pedal)
running or not), press the brake pedal, and press the N
the transmission will immediately engage the correct
button on the transmission gear selector.
gear according to the car’s speed.
When the vehicle is moving (with ignition ON), pressing
the NEUTRAL (N) button will engage N, regardless of
whether the brake pedal is pressed.
5
162 STARTING AND OPERATING
If the vehicle is stationary with the engine running and 2. Stop the engine and firmly engage the parking brake.
FIRST (1st) gear or REVERSE (R) engaged, the system
3. Release the brake pedal.
activates an acoustic signal and automatically places the
When parking on an incline, turn the front wheels toward
transmission in NEUTRAL (N) when:
the curb on a downhill slope and away from the curb on
The accelerator and/or brake pedal are not operated for
an uphill slope. Always chock the wheels when parking
at least three minutes.
on steep grades.
The brake pedal is pressed for longer than 10 minutes.
General Notes
The driver’s door is opened and the accelerator pedal or
When the vehicle is stopped and in gear, always keep the
the brake pedal are not operated for at least one and a
brake pedal pressed until you decide to set off, then
half seconds.
release the brake and accelerate gradually.
A fault has been detected in the transmission.
During prolonged stops with the engine running, it is
advisable to keep the transmission in NEUTRAL (N).
Parking The Vehicle
When parking and leaving the car, proceed as follows:
When stopped on an incline, always hold the vehicle in
1. Press the brake pedal and shift the transmission into place using the brakes. On steep inclines, Hill Start Assist
(HSA) will temporarily hold the car in position when the
First (1st).
brake pedal is released. If the accelerator pedal is not
STARTING AND OPERATING 163
applied after a short time, the car will roll back. Either ALFA DNA SYSTEM (DYNAMIC CAR CONTROL
reapply the brake (to hold the vehicle) or press the SYSTEM)
accelerator to climb the hill.
This vehicle is equipped with a “Alfa DNA” system lever
Only shift between FIRST (1st) and REVERSE (R) when (located on the center console). There are four modes of
operation to be selected according to driving style and
completely stopped, with the brake pedal pressed.
road conditions:
When necessary, it is possible to engage FIRST (1st),
REVERSE (R) or NEUTRAL (N) with the engine off, the Dynamic (This mode alters the transmission’s automatic
key at MAR-ON and the brake pressed. In this case, wait shift schedule for sportier driving [D]).
at least five seconds between one gear change and the Natural (mode for driving in normal conditions [N]).
next, in order to safeguard the operation of the hydraulic
All Weather (mode for driving in poor grip conditions,
system, and the pump in particular.
such as rain and snow [A]).
For uphill departures, it is advisable to accelerate gradually but fully immediately after releasing the parking Race (sports driving mode [D]).
brake or the brake pedal; this allows the engine to
temporarily increase the number of revs and tackle the
steepest gradients with more torque at the wheels.
5
164 STARTING AND OPERATING
This also acts on the dynamic car control systems (engine, The selected driving mode is indicated by the corresponding LED switching in the panel and by an indicagearbox/transmission, ESC system).
tion on the display.
Dynamic Mode
Activation
Move the Alfa DNA system lever upwards (to the letter
“D”) and hold in this position for half a second, until the
corresponding LED lights up and the Dynamic mode
activation indicator appears on the display.
Alfa DNA Mode Selector
Driving Modes
When Dynamic mode is activated, the turbocharger
pressure and engine oil temperature screen is displayed
automatically. When released, the Alfa DNA system lever
will return to the central position.
NOTE: Dynamic Mode will be inhibited until the vehicle
The Alfa DNA system lever will always return to the has accumulated 155 miles (250 km).
center position after use.
STARTING AND OPERATING 165
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and Anti-Slip Regu- Deactivation
lation (ASR) systems:
To deactivate Dynamic mode and return to Natural,
The ESC and ASR system ensures more enjoyable, move lever downwards (to letter “A”) and keep it in this
sportier driving while guaranteeing the stability of the position for half a second.
car.
The LED corresponding to Natural mode will light up
Electronic Q2 system:
and the Natural mode activation indication will appear
on the display.
The system increases vehicle stability while accelerating
Race Mode
on bends, improving the agility of the car.
Engine And Gearbox/Transmission:
Activation
The system adjusts the transmission shift calibration for Move the Alfa DNA system lever upwards (to the letter
“D”) and hold in this position for five seconds, until the
sportier shifting.
Race mode activation indicator appears on the display.
NOTE: In Dynamic mode, the engine response to the
accelerator pedal position increases considerably. Conse- When Race mode is activated, the longitudinal/lateral
accelerometer indicator screen (G-meter information) is
quently, driving is less fluid and comfortable.
displayed automatically. This considers gravitational acceleration (G).
5
166 STARTING AND OPERATING
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and Anti-Slip Regu- NOTE: In Race mode, the sensitivity of the accelerator
lation (ASR) systems:
pedal increases considerably. Consequently, driving is
less fluid and comfortable.
These systems are deactivated in order to ensure the
fullest sensation of sport, leaving the driver in full control In Race mode the transmission only works in MANUAL
of the vehicle. When the vehicle is in unstable conditions, mode. Refer to the ⬙Manual Operation⬙ in ⬙Starting and
the ESC reactivates automatically when the brake pedal Operating⬙ for further information.
is pressed until the ABS intervenes, thus returning the
Deactivation
vehicle to stable conditions. To deactivate the ESC and
ASR systems reactivate Race mode.
To deactivate Race mode and return to Dynamic mode,
move the Alfa DNA system lever downwards (to letter
Electronic Q2 system:
“A”) and keep it in this position for half a second.
The system increases vehicle stability while accelerating
The LED corresponding to Dynamic mode will light up
on bends, improving the agility of the car.
and the Dynamic mode activation indication will appear
Engine And Gearbox/Transmission:
on the display.
The system adjusts the transmission shift calibration for
sportier shifting.
STARTING AND OPERATING 167
until the corresponding LED lights up and the All
Weather mode activation indicator appears on the disElectronic Stability Control (ESC) and Anti-Slip Reguplay.
lation (ASR) systems:
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and Anti-Slip ReguESC and ASR system thresholds are aimed at providing
lation (ASR) systems:
comfort and safety in normal grip and driving conditions.
ESC and ASR system thresholds are aimed at ensuring
maximum safety in low-grip driving conditions. It is
Electronic Q2 system:
advisable to select All Weather mode in the presence of
The system is calibrated to ensure the best driving low-grip road surfaces.
comfort.
Electronic Q2 System:
Engine And Gearbox/Transmission:
The system is deactivated.
Standard response shifting.
Engine And Gearbox/Transmission:
All Weather Mode
Standard response shifting.
Activation
Natural Mode
Move the Alfa DNA system lever downwards (to the
letter “A”) and hold in this position for half a second,
5
168 STARTING AND OPERATING
The display will become grey (same screen as ⬙Natural⬙
mode) but without an indication of the Alfa DNA setting.
To deactivate All Weather mode and return to Natural
The display will also show a warning message.
mode, move the Alfa DNA system lever upwards (to
letter “D”) and keep it in this position for half a second. Please contact your authorized dealer for service.
Deactivation
NOTE:
Launch Control
When the engine is next started, All weather mode or The Launch Control strategy permits high-performance
Natural mode will be retained when the car is restarted. acceleration.
When the engine is next started, Race mode or Dynamic This strategy can be activated with vehicle at a standstill,
mode previously selected is not retained. The system will Race mode selected and FIRST (1st) gear engaged.
reactivate in Natural mode.
The sequence of operations to perform is as follows:
It is not possible to go directly from Dynamic mode to All 1. Press the brake pedal and hold it down.
Weather mode and vice versa. You must always first go
2. Press the accelerator pedal and hold it down.
back to Natural mode and then select the other mode.
3. Press the ⬙–⬙ paddle behind the steering wheel.
System Failure
In the event of system failure or a fault with the gear When the brake pedal is released, the car will start with
maximum acceleration. Despite the MANUAL mode, the
selector, no driving modes can be selected.
STARTING AND OPERATING 169
vehicle will automatically shift the gear to guarantee To discontinue the strategy, simply interrupt the above
maximum acceleration, once the correct shifting speed sequence of operations or release the accelerator pedal.
has been reached.
DRIVING ON SLIPPERY SURFACES
WARNING!
Launch Control is intended for off-highway or offroad use only and should not be used on any public
roadways. Use Launch Control only in a controlled
and dry track environment; within the limits of the
law. Actual Launch Control performance may change
depending on the surface and current traction conditions. The capabilities of the vehicle as measured by
the performance pages must never be exploited in a
reckless or dangerous manner, which can jeopardize
the user’s safety or the safety of others. Only a safe,
attentive, and skillful driver can prevent accidents.
Failure to follow this warning may result in serious
injury or death.
Acceleration
Rapid acceleration on snow covered, wet, or other slippery surfaces may cause the driving wheels to pull
erratically to the right or left. This phenomenon occurs
when there is a difference in the surface traction under
the rear (driving) wheels.
WARNING!
Rapid acceleration on slippery surfaces is dangerous.
Unequal traction can cause sudden pulling of the rear
wheels. You could lose control of the vehicle and
possibly have a collision. Accelerate slowly and
carefully whenever there is likely to be poor traction
(ice, snow, wet mud, loose sand, etc.).
5
170 STARTING AND OPERATING
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Limited Slip
When driving on wet or slushy roads, it is possible for a Differential (LSD) that reduces, but does not eliminate,
wedge of water to build up between the tire and road the amount of wheel slip across a given axle for improved handling.
surface. This is known as hydroplaning and may cause
partial or complete loss of vehicle control and stopping DRIVING THROUGH WATER
ability. To reduce this possibility, the following precauDriving through water more than a few inches/
tions should be observed:
centimeters deep will require extra caution to ensure
• Slow down during rainstorms or when the roads are safety and prevent damage to your vehicle.
slushy.
Flowing/Rising Water
• Slow down if the road has standing water or puddles.
Traction
• Replace tires when tread wear indicators first become
visible.
• Keep tires properly inflated.
• Maintain sufficient distance between your vehicle and
the vehicle in front of you to avoid a collision in a
sudden stop.
WARNING!
Do not drive on or across a road or path where water
is flowing and/or rising (as in storm run-off). Flowing water can wear away the road or path’s surface
and cause your vehicle to sink into deeper water.
Furthermore, flowing and/or rising water can carry
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 171
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
your vehicle away swiftly. Failure to follow this
warning may result in injuries that are serious or
fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
distances. Therefore, after driving through standing water, drive slowly and lightly press on the
brake pedal several times to dry the brakes.
• Failure to follow these warnings may result in
injuries that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and others around you.
Shallow Standing Water
Although your vehicle is capable of driving through
shallow standing water, consider the following Cautions
and Warnings before doing so.
CAUTION!
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s traction capabilities. Do not exceed 5 mph
(8 km/h) when driving through standing water.
• Driving through standing water limits your vehicle’s braking capabilities, which increases stopping
• Always check the depth of the standing water
before driving through it. Never drive through
standing water that is deeper than the bottom of
the tire rims mounted on the vehicle.
• Determine the condition of the road or the path
that is under water and if there are any obstacles in
the way before driving through the standing water.
(Continued)
(Continued)
WARNING!
5
172 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Do not exceed 5 mph (8 km/h) when driving
through standing water. This will minimize wave
effects.
• Driving through standing water may cause damage
to your vehicle’s drivetrain components. Always
inspect your vehicle’s fluids (i.e., engine oil, transmission, axle, etc.) for signs of contamination (i.e.,
fluid that is milky or foamy in appearance) after
driving through standing water. Do not continue to
operate the vehicle if any fluid appears contaminated, as this may result in further damage. Such
damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
• Getting water inside your vehicle’s engine can
cause it to lock up and stall out, and cause serious
internal damage to the engine. Such damage is not
covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
PARKING BRAKE
Before leaving the vehicle, make sure that the parking
brake is fully applied. Also, be certain to leave manual
transmission in REVERSE (R) or FIRST (1st) gear.
The parking brake lever is located in the central tunnel.
To apply the parking brake, pull the parking brake lever
up as firmly as possible. To release the parking brake,
pull the parking brake lever up slightly, press the center
button, then lower the parking brake lever completely.
STARTING AND OPERATING 173
should always be applied whenever the driver is not in
the vehicle.
WARNING!
Parking Brake Lever
When the parking brake is applied with the ignition
switch in the MAR (ACC/ON/RUN) position, the Brake
Warning Light in the instrument cluster will illuminate.
When parking on a hill, it is important to turn the front
wheels toward the curb on a downhill grade and away
from the curb on an uphill grade. The parking brake
• Never leave children alone in a vehicle, or with
access to an unlocked vehicle.
• Allowing children to be in a vehicle unattended is
dangerous for a number of reasons. A child or
others could be seriously or fatally injured. Children should be warned not to touch the parking
brake, brake pedal or the transmission gear selector.
• Do not leave the Key Fob in or near the vehicle or
in a location accessible to children. A child could
operate power windows, other controls, or move
the vehicle.
(Continued)
5
174 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Be sure the parking brake is fully disengaged
before driving; failure to do so can lead to brake
failure and a collision.
• Always fully apply the parking brake when leaving your vehicle, or it may roll and cause damage or
injury. Also be certain to leave a manual transmission in REVERSE or FIRST (1st) gear. Failure to do
so may allow the vehicle to roll and cause damage
or injury.
CAUTION!
If the Brake Warning Light remains on with the
parking brake released, a brake system malfunction
is indicated. Have the brake system serviced by an
authorized dealer immediately.
BRAKE SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with dual hydraulic brake
systems. If either of the two hydraulic systems loses
normal capability, the remaining system will still function. However, there will be some loss of overall braking
effectiveness. You may notice increased pedal travel
during application, greater pedal force required to slow
or stop, and potential activation of the “Brake System
Warning Light.”
In the event power assist is lost for any reason (i.e.,
repeated brake applications with the engine off) the
brakes will still function. However, the effort required to
brake the vehicle will be much greater than that required
with the power system operating.
STARTING AND OPERATING 175
ESC (ELECTRONIC STABILITY CONTROL)
SYSTEM
WARNING! (Continued)
• Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent
the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded by
prevailing road conditions. ESC cannot prevent all
collisions, including those resulting from excessive
speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or
hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent collisions
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Only a
safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent collisions.The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or
dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of others.
• Vehicle modifications, or failure to properly maintain your vehicle, may change the handling characteristics of your vehicle, and may negatively affect
the performance of the ESC system. Changes to the
steering system, suspension, braking system, tire
type and size or wheel size may adversely affect ESC
performance. Improperly inflated and unevenly
worn tires may also degrade ESC performance. Any
(Continued)
(Continued)
The ESC system improves the directional control and
stability of the vehicle in various driving conditions.
The ESC system corrects the car’s understeer and oversteer, distributing the brake force on the appropriate
wheels. The torque supplied by the engine can also be
reduced in order to maintain control of the car.
WARNING!
5
176 STARTING AND OPERATING
This vehicle’s advanced electronic brake control system
also includes: Electronic Brake Distribution (EBD), Antivehicle modification or poor vehicle maintenance Lock Brake System (ABS), Cornering Brake Control Systhat reduces the effectiveness of the ESC system can
tem (CBC), Drag Torque Control System (DTC), AntiSlip
increase the risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle Regulation System (ASR), Hill Start Assist (HSA), Hyrollover, personal injury and death.
draulic Brake Assistant System (HBA), ELECTRONIC Q2
system (E-Q2) and Ready Alert Brake (RAB). All of the
The ESC system uses sensors installed on the car to
systems work together to enhance vehicle stability and
determine the trajectory that the driver intends to follow
control in various driving conditions, and are commonly
and compares it with the car’s effective trajectory. When
referred to as ESC.
the real trajectory deviates from the desired trajectory, the
ESC system intervenes to counter the car’s understeer or System Activation
oversteer.
The ESC system activates automatically when the engine
WARNING! (Continued)
• Oversteer: occurs when the vehicle is turning more is started and can only be deactivated by selecting ⬙Race⬙
than it should according to the angle of the steering mode. Refer to the ⬙Six-Speed Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission⬙ in this section for further information.
wheel.
• Understeer: occurs when the vehicle is turning less
than it should according to the angle of the steering
wheel.
STARTING AND OPERATING 177
The system’s pump motor runs during an ABS stop to
provide regulated hydraulic pressure. The pump motor
This is indicated by the flashing of the warning light on
makes a low humming noise during operation, which is
the instrument panel, to inform the driver that the car is
normal.
in critical stability and grip conditions.
The ABS includes an amber ABS Warning Light. When
Electronic Brake Distribution System (EBD)
the light is illuminated, the ABS is not functioning. The
The EBD system is an integral part of the ESC system and system reverts to standard non-anti-lock brakes. Turning
intervenes during braking, distributing the brake force the ignition Off and On again may reset the ABS if the
optimally between front and rear wheels.
fault detected was only momentary.
System Intervention
This guarantees greater braking stability for the vehicle,
preventing sudden locking of the rear wheels and the
consequent instability of the vehicle.
Four-Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
The Four-Wheel ABS is designed to aid the driver in
maintaining vehicle control under adverse braking conditions. The system operates with a separate computer to
modulate hydraulic pressure, to prevent wheel lock-up
and to help avoid skidding on slippery surfaces.
WARNING!
• When the ABS intervenes and you feel the brake
pedal pulsating, do not reduce the pressure, but
hold it down firmly and confidently; in doing so
you will brake in the shortest distance possible,
depending on the current road conditions.
(Continued)
5
178 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• For maximum efficiency of the braking system, a
bedding-in period of about 311 miles (500 km) is
required: during this period it is advisable to avoid
sharp, repeated and prolonged braking.
• If the ABS intervenes, this indicates that the grip of
the tires on the road is nearing its limit: you must
slow down to a speed compatible with the available grip.
• The ABS can’t overrule the natural laws of physics,
and can’t increase the grip available according to
the condition of the road.
• The ABS cannot prevent accidents, including those
due to excessive speed on corners, driving on
low-grip surfaces or aquaplaning.
• The capability of the ABS must never be tested
irresponsibly and dangerously, in such a way as to
compromise personal safety and the safety of others.
• For the correct operation of the ABS, the tires must
of necessity be the same make and type on all
wheels, in perfect condition and, above all, of the
prescribed type and dimensions.
(Continued)
When you are in a severe braking condition involving the
use of the ABS, you will experience some pedal drop as
the vehicle comes to a stop. This is the result of the
system reverting to the base brake system.
Engagement of the ABS may be accompanied by a
pulsing sensation. You may also hear a clicking noise.
These occurrences are normal and indicate that the
system is functioning properly.
STARTING AND OPERATING 179
System Intervention
A slight pulsing of the brake pedal and noise indicates
the intervention of the ABS: this is completely normal
when the system intervenes.
Cornering Brake Control System (CBC)
The system acts when braking on corners, optimizing the
distribution of brake pressure on the four wheels: the
system prevents the wheels on the inside of the corner
(less affected by the weight of the car) from locking,
ensuring better stability and direction for the car.
Drag Torque Control System (DTC)
This is an integral part of the ESC system and intervenes
in the event of sudden downshifting, or during braking
when the ABS intervenes, restoring torque to the engine
and thus preventing excessive drag at the drive wheels,
which may lead the wheels to lock and a loss of car
stability, above all in low-grip conditions.
AntiSlip Regulation System (ASR)
WARNING!
• Electronic Stability Control (ESC) cannot prevent
the natural laws of physics from acting on the
vehicle, nor can it increase the traction afforded by
prevailing road conditions. ESC cannot prevent all
collisions, including those resulting from excessive
speed in turns, driving on very slippery surfaces, or
hydroplaning. ESC also cannot prevent collisions
resulting from loss of vehicle control due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Only a
safe, attentive, and skillful driver can prevent collisions.The capabilities of an ESC equipped vehicle must never be exploited in a reckless or
dangerous manner which could jeopardize the user’s safety or the safety of others.
(Continued)
5
180 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Vehicle modifications, or failure to properly maintain your vehicle, may change the handling characteristics of your vehicle, and may negatively affect
the performance of the ESC system. Changes to the
steering system, suspension, braking system, tire
type and size or wheel size may adversely affect ESC
performance. Improperly inflated and unevenly
worn tires may also degrade ESC performance. Any
vehicle modification or poor vehicle maintenance
that reduces the effectiveness of the ESC system can
increase the risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle
rollover, personal injury and death.
This is an integral part of the ESC system and automatically operates in the event of one or both drive wheels
slipping, loss of grip on wet roads (hydroplaning) and
acceleration on slippery, snowy or icy roads, etc.
Depending on the slipping conditions, two different
control systems are activated:
• If the slipping involves both drive wheels, the ASR
system intervenes, reducing the power transmitted by
the engine.
• If the slipping only involves one of the drive wheels, it
also intervenes automatically, braking the wheel that is
slipping.
System Intervention
This is indicated by the flashing of the warning light on
the instrument panel, to inform the driver that the car is
in critical stability and grip conditions.
STARTING AND OPERATING 181
When the two seconds have elapsed, without starting,
the system is automatically deactivated, gradually releasThis is an integral part of the ESC system and facilitates
ing the braking pressure. During this release stage, the
starting on slopes, activating automatically in the followtypical brake disengagement noise, indicating that the
ing cases:
car is going to move imminently, can be heard.
• Uphill: car stationary on a road with a gradient higher
NOTE:
than 5%, engine running, brake pressed and transmission in neutral (N) or gear other than reverse engaged. • HSA is not a parking brake; therefore, never leave the
vehicle without having engaged the parking brake,
• Downhill: car stationary on a road with a gradient
turned the engine off and engaged first gear, so that
higher than 5%, engine running, brake pressed and
the vehicle is parked in safe conditions.
reverse (R) gear engaged.
When setting off, the ESC system control unit maintains • There may be situations on small gradients (less than
8%), with vehicle laden, in which the Hill Holder
the braking pressure on the wheels until the engine
system may not activate, causing a slight reversing
torque necessary for starting is reached, or in any case for
motion and increasing the risk of collision with ana maximum of two seconds, allowing your right foot to
other vehicle or object. The driver is, in any case,
be moved easily from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
responsible for safe driving.
Hill Start Assist (HSA)
5
182 STARTING AND OPERATING
Hydraulic Brake Assistant System (HBA)
WARNING!
• The HBA system can’t overrule the natural laws of
physics, and can’t increase the grip available according to the condition of the road.
• The HBA system cannot prevent accidents, including those due to excessive speed on corners, driving on low-grip surfaces or aquaplaning.
• The capability of the HBA system must never be
tested irresponsibly and dangerously, in such a
way as to compromise the safety of the driver, the
other occupants of the car or any other road user.
The HBA system is designed to improve the car’s braking
capacity during emergency braking. The system detects
emergency braking by monitoring the speed and force
with which the brake pedal is pressed, and consequently
applies the optimal brake pressure. This can reduce the
braking distance, the HBA system therefore completes
the ABS.
Maximum assistance from the HBA system is obtained
pressing the brake pedal very quickly. In addition, the
brake pedal should be pressed continuously during
braking, avoiding intermittent presses, to get the most
out of the system.
Do not reduce pressure on the brake pedal until braking
is no longer necessary.
The HBA system is deactivated when the brake pedal is
released.
STARTING AND OPERATING 183
Electronic Q2 System (E-Q2)
TIRE SAFETY INFORMATION
The ⬙Electronic Q2⬙ system intervenes during accelera- Tire Markings
tion on corners, braking the inner drive wheel and thus
increasing the traction of the outer wheel (which bears
more of the car’s weight): the torque is thus distributed
optimally between the drive wheels in accordance with
the driving conditions and road surface, permitting particularly effective, sporty driving.
5
Ready Alert Brake System (RAB)
This function activates automatically if the accelerator
pedal is released rapidly, reducing the brake pad travel
(both at front and back), with the aim of preparing the
braking system and enhancing its responsiveness, thus
reducing the stopping distance in the event of subse- 1 — U.S. DOT Safety Standards 4 — Maximum Load
Code (TIN)
quent braking.
2 — Size Designation
3 — Service Description
5 — Maximum Pressure
6 — Treadwear, Traction and
Temperature Grades
184 STARTING AND OPERATING
• Temporary spare tires are designed for temporary
emergency use only. Temporary high pressure com• P (Passenger) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
pact spare tires have the letter “T” or “S” molded into
design standards. P-Metric tires have the letter “P”
the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example:
molded into the sidewall preceding the size designaT145/80D18 103M.
tion. Example: P215/65R15 95H.
• High flotation tire sizing is based on U.S. design
• European — Metric tire sizing is based on European
standards and it begins with the tire diameter molded
design standards. Tires designed to this standard have
into the sidewall. Example: 31x10.5 R15 LT.
the tire size molded into the sidewall beginning with
the section width. The letter ⬙P⬙ is absent from this tire
size designation. Example: 215/65R15 96H.
NOTE:
• LT (Light Truck) — Metric tire sizing is based on U.S.
design standards. The size designation for LT-Metric
tires is the same as for P-Metric tires except for the
letters “LT” that are molded into the sidewall preceding the size designation. Example: LT235/85R16.
STARTING AND OPERATING 185
Tire Sizing Chart
EXAMPLE:
Example Size Designation: P215/65R15XL 95H, 215/65R15 96H, LT235/85R16C, T145/80D18 103M, 31x10.5 R15 LT
P = Passenger car tire size based on U.S. design standards, or
ⴖ....blank....ⴖ = Passenger car tire based on European design standards, or
LT = Light truck tire based on U.S. design standards, or
T or S = Temporary spare tire or
31 = Overall diameter in inches (in)
215, 235, 145 = Section width in millimeters (mm)
65, 85, 80 = Aspect ratio in percent (%)
– Ratio of section height to section width of tire, or
10.5 = Section width in inches (in)
R = Construction code
– ⬙R⬙ means radial construction, or
– ⬙D⬙ means diagonal or bias construction
15, 16, 18 = Rim diameter in inches (in)
5
186 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
Service Description:
95 = Load Index
– A numerical code associated with the maximum load a tire can carry
H = Speed Symbol
– A symbol indicating the range of speeds at which a tire can carry a load corresponding to
its load index under certain operating conditions
– The maximum speed corresponding to the speed symbol should only be achieved under
specified operating conditions (i.e., tire pressure, vehicle loading, road conditions, and
posted speed limits)
Load Identification:
Absence of the following load identification symbols on the sidewall of the tire indicates a Standard Load (SL) tire:
• XL = Extra load (or reinforced) tire, or
• LL = Light load tire or
• C, D, E, F, G = Load range associated with the maximum load a tire can carry at a specified pressure
Maximum Load – Maximum load indicates the maximum load this tire is designed to carry
Maximum Pressure – Maximum pressure indicates the maximum permissible cold tire inflation pressure for this tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 187
Look for the TIN on the outboard side of black sidewall
The TIN may be found on one or both sides of the tire, tires as mounted on the vehicle. If the TIN is not found on
however, the date code may only be on one side. Tires the outboard side, then you will find it on the inboard
side of the tire.
with white sidewalls will have the full TIN, including the
date code, located on the white sidewall side of the tire.
Tire Identification Number (TIN)
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
DOT = Department of Transportation
– This symbol certifies that the tire is in compliance with the U.S. Department of Transportation tire
safety standards and is approved for highway use
MA = Code representing the tire manufacturing location (two digits)
L9 = Code representing the tire size (two digits)
ABCD = Code used by the tire manufacturer (one to four digits)
03 = Number representing the week in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 03 means the 3rd week
5
188 STARTING AND OPERATING
EXAMPLE:
DOT MA L9 ABCD 0301
01 = Number representing the year in which the tire was manufactured (two digits)
– 01 means the year 2001
– Prior to July 2000, tire manufacturers were only required to have one number to represent the year
in which the tire was manufactured. Example: 031 could represent the 3rd week of 1981 or 1991
STARTING AND OPERATING 189
Tire Terminology And Definitions
Term
B-Pillar
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Maximum Inflation Pressure
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
Tire Placard
Definition
The vehicle B-Pillar is the structural member of the body located
behind the front door.
Cold tire inflation pressure is defined as the tire pressure after
the vehicle has not been driven for at least three hours, or driven
less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three
hours. Inflation pressure is measured in units of PSI (pounds per
square inch) or kPa (kilopascals).
The maximum inflation pressure is the maximum permissible
cold tire inflation pressure for this tire. The maximum inflation
pressure is molded into the sidewall.
Vehicle manufacturer’s recommended cold tire inflation pressure
as shown on the tire placard.
A label permanently attached to the vehicle describing the vehicle’s loading capacity, the original equipment tire sizes and the
recommended cold tire inflation pressures.
5
190 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Loading And Tire Pressure
Tire And Loading Information Placard Location
NOTE: The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on
the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the driver’s
side door.
Example Tire Placard Location (B-Pillar)
Example Tire Placard Location (Door)
STARTING AND OPERATING 191
Tire And Loading Information Placard
3. Tire size designed for your vehicle.
4. Cold tire inflation pressures for the front, rear, and
spare tires.
Loading
The vehicle maximum load on the tire must not exceed
the load carrying capacity of the tire on your vehicle. You
will not exceed the tire’s load carrying capacity if you
adhere to the loading conditions, tire size, and cold tire
inflation pressures specified on the Tire and Loading
Information placard and in the “Vehicle Loading” section
of this manual.
Tire And Loading Information Placard
This placard tells you important information about the:
1. Number of people that can be carried in the vehicle.
2. Total weight your vehicle can carry.
NOTE: Under a maximum loaded vehicle condition,
gross axle weight ratings (GAWRs) for the front and rear
axles must not be exceeded. For further information on
GAWRs, vehicle loading, and trailer towing, refer to
“Vehicle Loading” in this section.
5
192 STARTING AND OPERATING
To determine the maximum loading conditions of your 4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of
vehicle, locate the statement “The combined weight of
cargo and luggage load capacity. For example, if
occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
“XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs (635 kg) and there will
XXX kg” on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
be five 150 lb (68 kg) passengers in your vehicle, the
The combined weight of occupants, cargo/luggage and
amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity
trailer tongue weight (if applicable) should never exceed
is 650 lbs (295 kg) (since 5 x 150 lbs (68 kg) = 750 lbs
the weight referenced here.
(340 kg), and 1400 lbs (635 kg) – 750 lbs (340 kg) =
650 lbs [295 kg]).
Steps For Determining Correct Load Limit
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occubeing loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not
pants and cargo should never exceed XXX lbs or
safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load
XXX kg” on your vehicle’s placard.
capacity calculated in step 4.
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and
passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX lbs or XXX kg.
STARTING AND OPERATING 193
NOTE:
• If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your
trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. The following table shows examples on how to calculate total
load, cargo/luggage, and towing capacities of your
vehicle with varying seating configurations and number and size of occupants. This table is for illustration
purposes only and may not be accurate for the seating
and load carry capacity of your vehicle.
• For the following example, the combined weight of
occupants and cargo should never exceed 865 lbs
(392 kg).
5
194 STARTING AND OPERATING
STARTING AND OPERATING 195
WARNING!
Overloading of your tires is dangerous. Overloading
can cause tire failure, affect vehicle handling, and
increase your stopping distance. Use tires of the
recommended load capacity for your vehicle. Never
overload them.
TIRES — GENERAL INFORMATION
Tire Pressure
Proper tire inflation pressure is essential to the safe and
satisfactory operation of your vehicle. Four primary areas
are affected by improper tire pressure:
• Safety and Vehicle Stability
Safety
WARNING!
• Improperly inflated tires are dangerous and can
cause collisions.
• Under-inflation increases tire flexing and can result in overheating and tire failure.
• Over-inflation reduces a tire’s ability to cushion
shock. Objects on the road and chuckholes can
cause damage that result in tire failure.
• Overinflated or under-inflated tires can affect vehicle handling and can fail suddenly, resulting in
loss of vehicle control.
• Unequal tire pressures can cause steering problems. You could lose control of your vehicle.
• Economy
• Tread Wear
• Ride Comfort
(Continued)
5
196 STARTING AND OPERATING
WARNING! (Continued)
• Unequal tire pressures from one side of the vehicle
to the other can cause the vehicle to drift to the
right or left.
• Always drive with each tire inflated to the recommended cold tire inflation pressure.
Economy
Underinflated tires will increase tire rolling resistance
resulting in higher fuel consumption.
Tread Wear
Improper cold tire inflation pressures can cause abnormal wear patterns and reduced tread life, resulting in the
Both under-inflation and over-inflation affect the stability need for earlier tire replacement.
of the vehicle and can produce a feeling of sluggish Ride Comfort And Vehicle Stability
response or over responsiveness in the steering.
Proper tire inflation contributes to a comfortable ride.
NOTE:
Over-inflation produces a jarring and uncomfortable
• Unequal tire pressures from side to side may cause ride.
erratic and unpredictable steering response.
Tire Inflation Pressures
• Unequal tire pressure from side to side may cause the The proper cold tire inflation pressure is listed on the
vehicle to drift left or right.
driver’s side B-Pillar or rear edge of the driver’s side
door.
STARTING AND OPERATING 197
At least once a month:
mile (1.6 km) after sitting for a minimum of three hours.
The cold tire inflation pressure must not exceed the
• Check and adjust tire pressure with a good quality
maximum inflation pressure molded into the tire sidepocket-type pressure gauge. Do not make a visual
wall.
judgement when determining proper inflation. Tires
may look properly inflated even when they are under- Check tire pressures more often if subject to a wide range
of outdoor temperatures, as tire pressures vary with
inflated.
temperature changes.
• Inspect tires for signs of tire wear or visible damage.
Tire pressures change by approximately 1 psi (7 kPa) per
12°F (7°C) of air temperature change. Keep this in mind
CAUTION!
when checking tire pressure inside a garage, especially in
After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure, althe winter.
ways reinstall the valve stem cap. This will prevent
Example: If garage temperature = 68°F (20°C) and the
moisture and dirt from entering the valve stem,
outside temperature = 32°F (0°C) then the cold tire
which could damage the valve stem.
inflation pressure should be increased by 3 psi (21 kPa),
Inflation pressures specified on the placard are always which equals 1 psi (7 kPa) for every 12°F (7°C) for this
“cold tire inflation pressure.” Cold tire inflation pressure outside temperature condition.
is defined as the tire pressure after the vehicle has not
been driven for at least three hours, or driven less than 1
5
198 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire pressure may increase from 2 to 6 psi (13 to 40 kPa)
during operation. DO NOT reduce this normal pressure
build up or your tire pressure will be too low.
Tire Pressures For High Speed Operation
WARNING!
High speed driving with your vehicle under maximum load is dangerous. The added strain on your
tires could cause them to fail. You could have a
serious collision. Do not drive a vehicle loaded to the
maximum capacity at continuous speeds above
75 mph (120 km/h).
The manufacturer advocates driving at safe speeds and
within posted speed limits. Where speed limits or conditions are such that the vehicle can be driven at high
speeds, maintaining correct tire inflation pressure is very
important. Increased tire pressure and reduced vehicle Radial Ply Tires
loading may be required for high-speed vehicle operation. Refer to your authorized tire dealer or original
WARNING!
equipment vehicle dealer for recommended safe operatCombining radial ply tires with other types of tires
ing speeds, loading and cold tire inflation pressures.
on your vehicle will cause your vehicle to handle
poorly. The instability could cause a collision. Always use radial ply tires in sets of four. Never
combine them with other types of tires.
STARTING AND OPERATING 199
Tire Repair
Tire Types
If your tire becomes damaged, it may be repaired if it All Season Tires — If Equipped
meets the following criteria:
All Season tires provide traction for all seasons (spring,
summer, fall and winter). Traction levels may vary be• The tire has not been driven on when flat.
tween different all season tires. All season tires can be
• The damage is only on the tread section of your tire
identified by the M+S, M&S, M/S or MS designation on
(sidewall damage is not repairable).
the tire sidewall. Use all season tires only in sets of four;
• The puncture is no greater than a ¼ of an inch (6 mm). failure to do so may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Consult an authorized tire dealer for tire repairs and
additional information.
Summer Or Three Season Tires — If Equipped
Damaged Run Flat tires, or Run Flat tires that have
experienced a loss of pressure should be replaced immediately with another Run Flat tire of identical size and
service description (Load Index and Speed Symbol).
Summer tires provide traction in both wet and dry
conditions, and are not intended to be driven in snow or
on ice. If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware these tires are not designed for winter or cold
driving conditions. Install winter tires on your vehicle
when ambient temperatures are less than 40°F (5°C) or if
roads are covered with ice or snow. For more information, contact an authorized dealer.
5
200 STARTING AND OPERATING
Summer tires do not contain the all season designation or
mountain/snowflake symbol on the tire sidewall. Use
summer tires only in sets of four; failure to do so may
adversely affect the safety and handling of your vehicle.
WARNING!
Do not use summer tires in snow/ice conditions. You
could lose vehicle control, resulting in severe injury
or death. Driving too fast for conditions also creates
the possibility of loss of vehicle control.
Snow Tires
Some areas of the country require the use of snow tires
during the winter. Snow tires can be identified by a
“mountain/snowflake” symbol on the tire sidewall.
If you need snow tires, select tires
equivalent in size and type to the original equipment tires. Use snow tires
only in sets of four; failure to do so
may adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Snow tires generally have lower speed ratings than what
was originally equipped with your vehicle and should
not be operated at sustained speeds over 75 mph
(120 km/h). For speeds above 75 mph (120 km/h) refer to
original equipment or an authorized tire dealer for
recommended safe operating speeds, loading and cold
tire inflation pressures.
STARTING AND OPERATING 201
While studded tires improve performance on ice, skid
and traction capability on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded tires. Some states prohibit studded tires; therefore, local laws should be
checked before using these tire types.
Run Flat Tires — If Equipped
Run Flat tires allow you the capability to drive 50 miles
(80 km) at 50 mph (80 km/h) after a rapid loss of inflation
pressure. This rapid loss of inflation is referred to as the
Run Flat mode. A Run Flat mode occurs when the tire
inflation pressure is of/or below 14 psi (96 kPa). Once a
Run Flat tire reaches the run flat mode it has limited
driving capabilities and needs to be replaced immediately. A Run Flat tire is not repairable.
It is not recommended driving a vehicle loaded at full
capacity or to tow a trailer while a tire is in the run flat
mode.
See the tire pressure monitoring section for more information.
Spare Tires — If Equipped
NOTE: For vehicles equipped with Tire Service Kit
instead of a spare tire, please refer to “Tire Service Kit” in
“What To Do In Emergencies” for further information.
CAUTION!
Because of the reduced ground clearance, do not take
your vehicle through an automatic car wash with a
compact or limited-use temporary spare installed.
Damage to the vehicle may result.
5
202 STARTING AND OPERATING
Spare Tire Matching Original Equipped Tire And
Wheel — If Equipped
Your vehicle may be equipped with a spare tire and
wheel equivalent in look and function to the original
equipment tire and wheel found on the front or rear axle
of your vehicle. This spare tire may be used in the tire
rotation for your vehicle. If your vehicle has this option,
refer to an authorized tire dealer for the recommended
tire rotation pattern.
Compact Spare Tire — If Equipped
The compact spare is for temporary emergency use only.
You can identify if your vehicle is equipped with a compact
spare by looking at the spare tire description on the Tire and
Loading Information Placard located on the driver’s side
door opening or on the sidewall of the tire. Compact spare
tire descriptions begin with the letter “T” or “S” preceding
the size designation. Example: T145/80D18 103M.
T, S = Temporary Spare Tire
Since this tire has limited tread life, the original equipment tire should be repaired (or replaced) and reinstalled
on your vehicle at the first opportunity.
Do not install a wheel cover or attempt to mount a
conventional tire on the compact spare wheel, since the
wheel is designed specifically for the compact spare tire.
Do not install more than one compact spare tire and
wheel on the vehicle at any given time.
WARNING!
Compact spares are for temporary emergency use
only. With these spares, do not drive more than
50 mph (80 km/h). Temporary use spares have limited
tread life. When the tread is worn to the tread wear
indicators, the temporary use spare tire needs to be
replaced. Be sure to follow the warnings, which
apply to your spare. Failure to do so could result in
spare tire failure and loss of vehicle control.
STARTING AND OPERATING 203
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the
The full size spare is for temporary emergency use only.
first opportunity.
This tire may look like the originally equipped tire on the
front or rear axle of your vehicle, but it is not. This spare
WARNING!
tire may have limited tread life. When the tread is worn
to the tread wear indicators, the temporary use full size Limited-use spares are for emergency use only. Inspare tire needs to be replaced. Since it is not the same as
stallation of this limited-use spare tire affects vehicle
your original equipment tire, replace (or repair) the handling. With this tire, do not drive more than the
original equipment tire and reinstall on the vehicle at the speed listed on the limit-use spare wheel. Keep
first opportunity.
inflated to the cold tire inflation pressures listed on
Full Size Spare — If Equipped
Limited-Use Spare — If Equipped
The limited-use spare tire is for temporary emergency
use only. This tire is identified by a label located on the
limited-use spare wheel. This label contains the driving
limitations for this spare. This tire may look like the
original equipped tire on the front or rear axle of your
vehicle, but it is not. Installation of this limited-use spare
tire affects vehicle handling. Since it is not the same as
your Tire and Loading Information Placard located
on the driver’s side B-Pillar or the rear edge of the
driver’s side door. Replace (or repair) the original
equipment tire at the first opportunity and reinstall it
on your vehicle. Failure to do so could result in loss
of vehicle control.
5
204 STARTING AND OPERATING
Tire Spinning
Tread Wear Indicators
When stuck in mud, sand, snow, or ice conditions, do not Tread wear indicators are in the original equipment tires
spin your vehicle’s wheels above 30 mph (48 km/h) or to help you in determining when your tires should be
for longer than 30 seconds continuously without stop- replaced.
ping.
Refer to “Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause tire damage or failure. A tire could explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than
30 mph (48 km/h) for more than 30 seconds continuously when you are stuck, and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
1 — Worn Tire
2 — New Tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 205
These indicators are molded into the bottom of the tread • Performance tires, tires with a speed rating of V or
higher, and summer tires typically have a reduced
grooves. They will appear as bands when the tread depth
tread life. Rotation of these tires per the vehicle mainbecomes a 1/16 of an inch (2 mm). When the tread is
tenance schedule is highly recommended.
worn to the tread wear indicators, the tire should be
replaced. Refer to “Replacement Tires” in this section for
further information.
WARNING!
Life Of Tire
The service life of a tire is dependent upon varying
factors including, but not limited to:
• Driving style.
Tires and the spare tire should be replaced after six
years, regardless of the remaining tread. Failure to
follow this warning can result in sudden tire failure.
You could lose control and have a collision resulting
in serious injury or death.
• Tire pressure - Improper cold tire inflation pressures
Keep dismounted tires in a cool, dry place with as little
can cause uneven wear patterns to develop across the
exposure to light as possible. Protect tires from contact
tire tread. These abnormal wear patterns will reduce
with oil, grease, and gasoline.
tread life, resulting in the need for earlier tire replacement.
• Distance driven.
5
206 STARTING AND OPERATING
affect your vehicle’s handling. If you ever replace a
wheel, make sure that the wheel’s specifications match
The tires on your new vehicle provide a balance of many
those of the original wheels.
characteristics. They should be inspected regularly for
wear and correct cold tire inflation pressures. The manu- It is recommended you contact your authorized tire
facturer strongly recommends that you use tires equiva- dealer or original equipment dealer with any questions
lent to the originals in size, quality and performance you may have on tire specifications or capability. Failure
when replacement is needed. Refer to the paragraph on to use equivalent replacement tires may adversely affect
“Tread Wear Indicator.” Refer to the Tire and Loading the safety, handling, and ride of your vehicle.
Information placard or the Vehicle Certification Label for
the size designation of your tire. The Load Index and
WARNING!
Speed Symbol for your tire will be found on the original
equipment tire sidewall. See the Tire Sizing Chart ex- • Do not use a tire, wheel size or rating other than
that specified for your vehicle. Some combinations
ample found in the Tire Safety Information section of this
of unapproved tires and wheels may change susmanual for more information relating to the Load Index
pension dimensions and performance characterisand Speed Symbol of a tire.
tics, resulting in changes to steering, handling, and
It is recommended to replace the two front tires or two
rear tires as a pair. Replacing just one tire can seriously
(Continued)
Replacement Tires
STARTING AND OPERATING 207
WARNING! (Continued)
CAUTION!
braking of your vehicle. This can cause unpredictable handling and stress to steering and suspension components. You could lose control and have
a collision resulting in serious injury or death. Use
only the tire and wheel sizes with load ratings
approved for your vehicle.
• Never use a tire with a smaller load index or
capacity, other than what was originally equipped
on your vehicle. Using a tire with a smaller load
index could result in tire overloading and failure.
You could lose control and have a collision.
• Failure to equip your vehicle with tires having
adequate speed capability can result in sudden tire
failure and loss of vehicle control.
Replacing original tires with tires of a different size
may result in false speedometer and odometer readings.
TIRE CHAINS (TRACTION DEVICES)
Use of traction devices require sufficient tire-to-body
clearance. Follow these recommendations to guard
against damage.
• Traction device must be of proper size for the tire, as
recommended by the traction device manufacturer.
• Install on Rear Tires Only.
• Reduced size snow chains with a maximum projection
of 7 mm beyond the tire profile can be fitted on cars
equipped with 235/40 R18 rear tire.
5
208 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
To avoid damage to your vehicle or tires, observe the
following precautions:
• Because of restricted traction device clearance between tires and other suspension components, it is
important that only traction devices in good condition are used. Broken devices can cause serious
damage. Stop the vehicle immediately if noise
occurs that could indicate device breakage. Remove
the damaged parts of the device before further use.
• Install device as tightly as possible and then retighten after driving about ½ mile (0.8 km).
• Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Drive cautiously and avoid severe turns and large
bumps, especially with a loaded vehicle.
• Do not drive for a prolonged period on dry pavement.
(Continued)
• Observe the traction device manufacturer’s instructions on the method of installation, operating
speed, and conditions for use. Always use the
suggested operating speed of the device manufacturer’s if it is less than 30 mph (48 km/h).
• Do not use traction devices on a compact spare tire.
TIRE ROTATION RECOMMENDATIONS
Due to tire design and size, tire rotations on this vehicle
are not possible.
STARTING AND OPERATING 209
NOTE: For AR 4C models, where available, the vehicle
may be equipped with high performance tires that guarantee high grip performance with little increase of wear.
Alfa Romeo, in collaboration with Pirelli, developed a
specific high performance tire for the 4C model. A dedicated Pirelli PZero, identified with an AR mark, guarantees
this vehicle to obtain the highest performance capable.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)
three hour period. The cold tire inflation pressure must
not exceed the maximum inflation pressure molded into
the tire sidewall. Refer to “Tires – General Information”
in “Starting and Operating” for information on how to
properly inflate the vehicle’s tires. The tire pressure will
also increase as the vehicle is driven, this is normal and
there should be no adjustment for this increased pressure.
The TPMS will warn the driver of a low tire pressure if
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) will warn the the tire pressure falls below the low pressure warning
driver of a low tire pressure based on the vehicle recom- limit for any reason, including low temperature effects, or
mended cold tire pressure.
natural pressure loss through the tire.
The tire pressure will vary with temperature by about 1 The TPMS will continue to warn the driver of low tire
psi (7 kPa) for every 12° F (6.5° C). This means that when pressure as long as the condition exists, and will not turn
the outside temperature decreases, the tire pressure will off until the tire pressure is at or above the recommended
decrease. Tire pressure should always be set based on cold tire pressure on the placard. Once the low tire
cold inflation tire pressure. This is defined as the tire pressure warning (Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
pressure after the vehicle has not been driven for at least Light) illuminates, you must increase the tire pressure to
three hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km) after a
5
210 STARTING AND OPERATING
the recommended cold tire pressure in order for the Tire are inflated to the vehicle’s recommended cold tire presPressure Monitoring Telltale Light to turn off. The system sure value.
will automatically update and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn off once the system receives
CAUTION!
the updated tire pressures. The vehicle may need to be
driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph (24 km/h) in • The TPMS has been optimized for the original
equipment tires and wheels. TPMS pressures and
order for the TPMS to receive this information.
warnings have been established for the tire size
For example, your vehicle may have a recommended
equipped on your vehicle. Undesirable system opcold (parked for more than three hours) tire pressure of
eration or sensor damage may result when using
30 psi (207 kPa). If the ambient temperature is 68° F (20°
replacement equipment that is not of the same size,
C) and the measured tire pressure is 27 psi (186 kPa), a
type, and/or style. Aftermarket wheels can cause
temperature drop to 20° F (-7° C) will decrease the tire
sensor damage. Using aftermarket tire sealants may
pressure to approximately 23 psi (159 kPa). This tire
cause the Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
pressure is sufficiently low enough to turn on the Tire
sensor to become inoperable. After using an afterPressure Monitoring Telltale Light. Driving the vehicle
market tire sealant it is recommended that you take
may cause the tire pressure to rise to approximately 27
your vehicle to your an authorized dealership to
psi (186 kPa), but the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
have your sensor function checked.
Light will still be on. In this situation, the Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light will turn off only after the tires
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 211
CAUTION! (Continued)
• After inspecting or adjusting the tire pressure,
always reinstall the valve stem cap. This will
prevent moisture and dirt from entering the valve
stem, which could damage the Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensor.
NOTE:
• The TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure using an accurate tire gauge, even
if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger
illumination of the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale
Light.
• Seasonal temperature changes will affect tire pressure,
and the TPMS will monitor the actual tire pressure in
the tire.
• The TPMS is not intended to replace normal tire care
and maintenance, or to provide warning of a tire Base System
failure or condition.
• The TPMS should not be used as a tire pressure gauge
while adjusting your tire pressure.
This is the TPMS warning indicator located in the
instrument cluster.
• Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes
the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.
Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire
tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
The TPMS uses wireless technology with wheel rim
mounted electronic sensors to monitor tire pressure levels. Sensors, mounted to each wheel as part of the valve
stem, transmit tire pressure readings to the Receiver
Module.
5
212 STARTING AND OPERATING
NOTE: It is particularly important for you to check the Pressure Monitoring Light will extinguish once the uptire pressure in all of the tires on your vehicle regularly dated tire pressures have been received. The vehicle may
need to be driven for up to 20 minutes above 15 mph
and to maintain the proper pressure.
(24 km/h) to receive this information.
The TPMS consists of the following components:
Check TPMS Warnings
• Receiver Module.
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on
• Four Tire Pressure Monitoring Sensors.
and off for 75 seconds and remain on solid when a system
fault is detected, the “TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
• Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light.
UNAVAILABLE” text message will display. If the igniTire Pressure Monitoring Low Pressure Warnings
tion key is cycled, this sequence will repeat providing the
The Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will illumi- system fault still exists. The Tire Pressure Monitoring
nate in the instrument cluster, an audible chime will be Telltale Light will turn off when the fault condition no
activated, and the “Check left or right front/rear tire” longer exists. A system fault can occur with any of the
text message will display when one or more of the four following scenarios:
active road tire pressures are low. Should this occur, you
should stop as soon as possible, check the inflation 1. Jamming due to electronic devices or driving next to
facilities emitting the same radio frequencies as the
pressure of each tire on your vehicle, and inflate each tire
TPM sensors.
to the vehicle’s recommended cold placard pressure
value. The system will automatically update and the Tire
STARTING AND OPERATING 213
2. Installing some form of aftermarket window tinting 3. However, after driving the vehicle for up to 20 minthat affects radio wave signals.
utes above 15 mph (24 km/h), the Tire Pressure
Monitoring Telltale Light will flash on and off for 75
3. Snow or ice around the wheels or wheel housings.
seconds and then remain on solid.
4. Using tire chains on the vehicle.
4. This occurs for each subsequent ignition key cycle, a
5. Using wheels/tires not equipped with TPM sensors.
chime will sound and the Tire Pressure Monitoring
Telltale Light will flash on and off for 75 seconds and
NOTE: Your vehicle may be equipped with a compact
then remain on solid.
spare wheel and tire assembly.
5. Once you repair or replace the original road tire and
1. The compact spare tire does not have a tire pressure
reinstall it on the vehicle in place of the compact spare
monitoring sensor. Therefore, the TPMS will not monitire, the TPMS will update automatically and the Tire
tor the tire pressure in the compact spare tire.
Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light will turn OFF, as
long as no tire pressure is below the low-pressure
2. If you install the compact spare tire in place of a road
warning limit in any of the four active road tires. The
tire that has a pressure below the low-pressure warning limit, upon the next ignition key cycle, a chime will
vehicle may need to be driven for up to 20 minutes
above 15 mph (24 km/h) in order for the TPMS to
sound and the Tire Pressure Monitoring Telltale Light
receive this information.
will still turn ON due to the low tire.
5
214 STARTING AND OPERATING
General Information
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and
RSS 210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the
following conditions:
FUEL REQUIREMENTS — 1.750 Turbo
The 1.750 turbo engine is designed to meet
all emissions regulations and provide excellent fuel economy and performance
• This device may not cause harmful interference.
when using high-quality premium un• This device must accept any interference received,
leaded gasoline with an octane rating of
including interference that may cause undesired op- Only 91 or higher.
eration.
Light spark knock at low engine speeds is not harmful to
The tire pressure sensors are covered under one of the your engine. However, continued heavy spark knock at
following licenses:
high speeds can cause damage and immediate service is
required.
United States
MRXC4W4MA4
Poor quality gasoline can cause problems such as hard
Canada
2546A-C4W4MA4
starting, stalling and hesitations. If you experience these
(Single)
symptoms, try another brand of gasoline (with the appropriate octane rating for your engine) before considering service for the vehicle.
STARTING AND OPERATING 215
Reformulated Gasoline
CAUTION!
Many areas of the country require the use of cleaner
burning gasoline referred to as “Reformulated Gasoline.”
Reformulated gasoline contain oxygenates and are specifically blended to reduce vehicle emissions and improve air quality.
Do not use gasoline containing Methanol or E-85
Ethanol. Use of these blends may result in starting
and drivability problems and may damage critical
fuel system components.
The manufacturer supports the use of reformulated gasoline. Properly blended reformulated gasoline will provide excellent performance and durability of engine and
fuel system components.
Problems that result from using methanol/gasoline
blends are not the responsibility of the manufacturer.
While MTBE is an oxygenate made from Methanol, it
does not have the negative effects of Methanol.
Gasoline/Oxygenate Blends
MMT In Gasoline
Some fuel suppliers blend unleaded gasoline with oxygenates such as 10% Ethanol, Methyl Tert-Butyl Ether
(MTBE), and Ethyl Tret-Butyl Ether (ETBE). Oxygenates
are required in some areas of the country during the
winter months to reduce carbon monoxide emissions.
Fuels blended with these oxygenates may be used in
your vehicle.
Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl (MMT)
is a manganese-containing metallic additive that is
blended into some gasoline to increase octane. Gasoline
blended with MMT provides no performance advantage
beyond gasoline of the same octane number without
MMT. Gasoline blended with MMT reduces spark plug
life and reduces emissions system performance in some
5
216 STARTING AND OPERATING
vehicles. The manufacturer recommends that gasoline Fuel System Cautions
without MMT be used in your vehicle. The MMT content
of gasoline may not be indicated on the gasoline pump,
CAUTION!
therefore, you should ask your gasoline retailer whether
the gasoline contains MMT. MMT is prohibited in Federal Follow these guidelines to maintain your vehicle’s
performance:
and California reformulated gasoline.
• The use of leaded gas is prohibited by Federal law.
Materials Added To Fuel
Using leaded gasoline can impair engine performance and damage the emissions control system.
All gasoline sold in the United States is required to
•
An out-of-tune engine or certain fuel or ignition
contain effective detergent additives. Use of additional
malfunctions can cause the catalytic converter to
detergents or other additives is not needed under normal
overheat. If you notice a pungent burning odor or
conditions and they would result in additional cost.
some light smoke, your engine may be out of tune
Therefore, you should not have to add anything to the
or malfunctioning and may require immediate serfuel.
vice. Contact your authorized dealer for service
assistance.
(Continued)
STARTING AND OPERATING 217
CAUTION! (Continued)
• The use of fuel additives, which are now being
sold as octane enhancers, is not recommended.
Most of these products contain high concentrations
of methanol. Fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems resulting from the use of such
fuels or additives is not the responsibility of the
manufacturer.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with the emissions control
system can result in civil penalties being assessed against
you.
Carbon Monoxide Warnings
WARNING!
Carbon monoxide (CO) in exhaust gases is deadly.
Follow the precautions below to prevent carbon
monoxide poisoning:
• Do not inhale exhaust gases. They contain carbon
monoxide, a colorless and odorless gas, which can
kill. Never run the engine in a closed area, such as a
garage, and never sit in a parked vehicle with the
engine running for an extended period. If the vehicle
is stopped in an open area with the engine running
for more than a short period, adjust the ventilation
system to force fresh, outside air into the vehicle.
• Guard against carbon monoxide with proper maintenance. Have the exhaust system inspected every
time the vehicle is raised. Have any abnormal
conditions repaired promptly. Until repaired, drive
with all side windows fully open.
5
218 STARTING AND OPERATING
ADDING FUEL/SMART FUEL
NOTE:
• The ⬙Smart Fuel⬙ is a device placed on the top of the
filler pipe, it opens and closes automatically when the
fuel nozzle is inserted or extracted.
• Only the correct nozzle size diameter allows the flap
door to open when the nozzle is inserted.
Refueling Procedure
1. Open the fuel filler door pulling towards outside.
Fuel Filler Door Location
2. There is no fuel filler cap. A flap door inside the pipe
seals the system.
STARTING AND OPERATING 219
4. At the end of refueling, before removing the nozzle,
wait at least 10 seconds to allow the fuel to flow within
the tank.
5. Remove the fuel nozzle from the filler pipe and then
close the fuel door.
Emergency Gas Can Refueling:
Most gas cans will not open the flapper door.
A funnel is provided to open the flapper door to allow
emergency refueling with a gas can.
Fuel Nozzle Location
1. Retrieve the appropriate funnel from the storage area
in the luggage compartment.
3. Insert the fuel nozzle into the filler pipe (the nozzle
opens and holds the flap door while refueling) and 2. Insert funnel into same filler pipe opening as the fuel
start refueling – when the fuel nozzle “clicks” or shuts
nozzle.
off, the fuel tank is full.
5
220 STARTING AND OPERATING
CAUTION!
To avoid fuel spillage and overfilling, do not “top
off” the fuel tank after filling.
WARNING!
Emergency Fuel Fill Location
3. Ensure funnel is inserted fully to hold flapper door
open.
4. Pour fuel into funnel opening.
5. Remove funnel from filler pipe, clean off prior to
putting back in the storage area.
• Never have any smoking materials lit in or near the
vehicle when the fuel door is open or the tank is
being filled.
• Never add fuel when the engine is running. This is
in violation of most state and federal fire regulations and may cause the “Malfunction Indicator
Light” to turn on.
• A fire may result if fuel is pumped into a portable
container that is inside of a vehicle. You could be
burned. Always place fuel containers on the
ground while filling.
STARTING AND OPERATING 221
TRAILER TOWING
Trailer towing with this vehicle is not recommended.
RECREATIONAL TOWING (BEHIND
MOTORHOME, ETC.)
Towing This Vehicle Behind Another Vehicle
NOTE: This vehicle may be towed on a flatbed or
vehicle trailer provided all four wheels are OFF the
ground.
CAUTION!
• DO NOT flat tow this vehicle. Damage to the
drivetrain will result.
• Do not dolly tow this vehicle. Use of a towing dolly
can cause significant damage to your vehicle. Damage from improper towing is not covered under the
New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
• Towing this vehicle in violation of the above requirements can cause severe transmission damage.
Damage from improper towing is not covered under the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
5
222 STARTING AND OPERATING
Towing Condition
Flat Tow
Dolly Tow
On Trailer
Wheels OFF the Ground
None
Front
Rear
All
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission
NOT ALLOWED
NOT ALLOWED
NOT ALLOWED
OK
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CONTENTS
䡵 HAZARD WARNING FLASHER . . . . . . . . . . .224
▫ Jump-Starting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .234
䡵 IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS . . . . . . . . . . . .224 䡵 FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
䡵 WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE
䡵 ENHANCED ACCIDENT RESPONSE
SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .238
▫ Torque Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .226 䡵 FRONT TOW EYE USAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
䡵 TIRE SERVICE KIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228 䡵 FIRE EXTINGUISHER — IF EQUIPPED . . . . . . .243
䡵 JUMP-STARTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
▫ Preparations For Jump-Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . .233
6
224 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER
IF YOUR ENGINE OVERHEATS
The Hazard Warning flasher switch is located on the In any of the following situations, you can reduce the
center console.
potential for overheating by taking the appropriate action.
Press the switch to turn on the Hazard Warning
flasher. When the switch is activated, all direc- • On the highways — slow down.
tional turn signals will flash on and off to warn oncoming • In city traffic — while stopped, place the transmission
traffic of an emergency. Press the switch a second time to
in NEUTRAL, but do not increase engine idle speed.
turn off the Hazard Warning flasher.
NOTE: There are steps that you can take to slow down
This is an emergency warning system and it should not an impending overheat condition:
be used when the vehicle is in motion. Use it when your
vehicle is disabled and it is creating a safety hazard for • If your air conditioner (A/C) is on, turn it off. The A/C
system adds heat to the engine cooling system and
other motorists.
turning the A/C off can help remove this heat.
When you must leave the vehicle to seek assistance, the
Hazard Warning flasher will continue to operate even • You can also turn the temperature control to maximum
heat, the mode control to floor and the blower control
though the ignition is placed in the OFF position.
to high. This allows the heater core to act as a
NOTE: With extended use the Hazard Warning flasher
supplement to the radiator and aids in removing heat
may wear down your battery.
from the engine cooling system.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 225
CAUTION!
WARNING!
Driving with a hot cooling system could damage
your vehicle. If the temperature gauge reads 240°F
(116°C) or greater pull over and stop the vehicle. Idle
the vehicle with the air conditioner turned off until
the coolant temperature drops back into the normal
range 200–230°F (93–110°C). The digital warning light
may switch on (together with a message on the
display) to indicate that the coolant temperature is
too high; in this case, stop the engine and call for
service.
You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had time
to cool. Never try to open a cooling system pressure
cap when the radiator or coolant bottle is hot.
WHEEL AND TIRE TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Proper lug nut/bolt torque is very important to ensure
that the wheel is properly mounted to the vehicle. Any
time a wheel has been removed and reinstalled on the
vehicle the lug nuts/bolts should be torqued using a
properly calibrated torque wrench.
6
226 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Torque Specifications
Lug Nut/Bolt Torque
**Lug Nut/
Bolt Size
72 Ft-Lbs (98 N·m)
M12 x 1.25
Lug Nut/
Bolt
Socket
Size
17 mm
**Use only Alfa Romeo recommended lug nuts/bolts and
clean or remove any dirt or oil before tightening.
Inspect the wheel mounting surface prior to mounting
the tire and remove any corrosion or loose particles.
Wheel Mounting Surface
Tighten the lug nuts/bolts in a star pattern until each
nut/bolt has been tightened twice.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 227
WARNING!
To avoid the risk of forcing the vehicle off the jack,
do not tighten the lug nuts fully until the vehicle has
been lowered. Failure to follow this warning may
result in personal injury.
6
Torque Patterns
After 25 miles (40 km) check the lug nut/bolt torque to be
sure that all the lug nuts/bolts are properly seated
against the wheel.
228 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
TIRE SERVICE KIT
If a tire is punctured, you can make a first emergency
repair using the Tire Service Kit located in the rear
storage area under the decklid.
Tire punctures of up to 1/4” (6 mm) can be repaired; the
kit can be used in all weather conditions. Do not remove
the foreign object from the punctured tire, i.e., screw or
nail.
Remove the Tire Service Kit from the vehicle, take it out
from the bag and place it near the punctured tire. Screw
the clear flexible filling tube to the tire valve.
Tire Service Kit Components
1
2
3
4
5
—
—
—
—
—
Power Plug (located on bottom side of Tire Service Kit)
Sealant Hose (Clear)
Power Button
Pressure Gauge
Sealant Bottle
WARNING!
• Do not attempt to seal a tire on the side of the
vehicle closest to traffic. Pull far enough off the
road to avoid the danger of being hit when using
the Tire Service Kit.
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 229
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
• Do not use Tire Service Kit or drive the vehicle
under the following circumstances:
– If the puncture in the tire tread is approximately
1/4” (6 mm) or larger.
– If the tire has any sidewall damage.
– If the tire has any damage from driving with
extremely low tire pressure.
– If the tire has any damage from driving on a flat
tire.
– If the wheel has any damage.
– If you are unsure of the condition of the tire or
the wheel.
• Keep Tire Service Kit away from open flames or
heat source.
• A loose Tire Service Kit thrown forward in a
collision or hard stop could endanger the occupants
of the vehicle. Always stow the Tire Service Kit in
the place provided. Failure to follow these warnings can result in injuries that are serious or fatal to
you, your passengers, and others around you.
• Take care not to allow the contents of Tire Service
Kit to come in contact with hair, eyes, or clothing.
Tire Service Kit sealant is harmful if inhaled,
swallowed, or absorbed through the skin. It causes
skin, eye, and respiratory irritation. Flush immediately with plenty of water if there is any contact
with eyes or skin. Change clothing as soon as
possible, if there is any contact with clothing.
(Continued)
(Continued)
6
230 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING! (Continued)
• Tire Service Kit Sealant solution contains latex. In case
of an allergic reaction or rash, consult a physician
immediately. Keep Tire Service Kit out of reach of
children. If swallowed, rinse mouth immediately with
plenty of water and drink plenty of water. Do not
induce vomiting! Consult a physician immediately.
Insert the power plug into the vehicle power outlet
socket. Start the vehicle engine.
Press the Tire Service Kit power button to the “I”
position. The electric compressor will be turned on,
sealant and air will inflate the tire.
Minimum 26 psi (1.8 bar) of pressure should be reached
within 20 minutes. If the pressure has not been reached
turn off and remove the Tire Service Kit, drive the vehicle
30 feet (10 meters) back and forth, to better distribute the
sealant inside the tire.
Attach the clear flexible filling tube of the compressor
directly to the tire valve and repeat the inflation process.
When the correct pressure has been reached, start driving
the vehicle to uniformly distribute the sealant inside the
tire. After 10 minutes, stop and check the tire pressure. If
the pressure is below 19 psi (1.3 bar), do not drive the
vehicle, as the tire is too damaged, contact the nearest
Authorized Dealer.
WARNING!
Tire Service Kit is not a permanent flat tire repair.
Have the tire inspected and repaired or replaced after
using Tire Service Kit. Do not exceed 65 mph
(110 km/h) until the tire is repaired or replaced.
Failure to follow this warning can result in injuries
that are serious or fatal to you, your passengers, and
others around you. Have the tire checked as soon as
possible at an Authorized Dealer.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 231
If the pressure is at 19 psi (1.3 bar) or above repeat the
inflation process to reach the correct tire pressure and
continue driving.
Peel off the warning label from the bottle and place it on
the dashboard as a reminder to the driver that the tire has
been treated with Tire Service Kit.
WARNING!
6
The metal end fitting from Power Plug may get hot
after use, so it should be handled carefully.
NOTE: Replace the sealant canister prior to the expiration date at your Authorized Dealer.
Tire Service Kit Expiration Date Location
WARNING!
Store the sealant canister in its special compartment,
away from sources of heat.
232 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
JUMP-STARTING
If your vehicle has a discharged battery it can be jumpstarted using a set of jumper cables and a battery in
another vehicle or by using a portable battery booster
pack. Jump-starting can be dangerous if done improperly
so please follow the procedures in this section carefully.
NOTE: When using a portable battery booster pack
follow the manufacturer’s operating instructions and
precautions.
CAUTION!
Do not use a portable battery booster pack or any
other booster source with a system voltage greater
than 12 Volts or damage to the battery, starter motor,
alternator or electrical system may occur.
WARNING!
Do not attempt jump-starting if the battery is frozen.
It could rupture or explode and cause personal injury.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 233
Preparations For Jump-Start
The battery in your vehicle is located on the left side of
the engine compartment. To access the battery remove
the protective cover.
WARNING!
• Remove any metal jewelry such as rings, watch
bands and bracelets that could make an inadvertent
electrical contact. You could be seriously injured.
• Batteries contain sulfuric acid that can burn your
skin or eyes and generate hydrogen gas which is
flammable and explosive. Keep open flames or
sparks away from the battery.
6
NOTE: Be sure that the disconnected ends of the cables
do not touch while still connected to the other vehicle.
1. Firmly apply the parking brake, and turn the ignition
OFF.
Battery Location
2. Turn off the heater, radio, and all unnecessary electrical accessories.
3. To remove the protective cover off the battery, pull
upward on the cover.
234 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
4. If using another vehicle to jump-start the battery, park
the vehicle within the jumper cables reach, set the
parking brake and make sure the ignition is OFF.
WARNING!
CAUTION!
Failure to follow these procedures could result in
damage to the charging system of the booster vehicle
or the discharged vehicle.
Do not allow vehicles to touch each other as this
could establish a ground connection and personal
injury could result.
Jump-Starting Procedure
WARNING!
Failure to follow this jump-starting procedure could
result in personal injury or property damage due to
battery explosion.
Positive (+) Battery Post
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 235
Connecting The Jumper Cables
1. Connect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable to the
positive (+) post of the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
2. Connect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable to the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
WARNING!
Do not connect the jumper cable to the negative (-)
post of the discharged battery. The resulting electrical spark could cause the battery to explode and
could result in personal injury. Only use the specific
ground point, do not use any other exposed metal
parts.
3. Connect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable to the
negative (-) post of the booster battery.
5.
4. Connect the opposite end of the negative (-) jumper
cable to a good engine ground of the vehicle with the
discharged battery (exposed metal part of the engine)
away from the battery and the fuel injection system. 6.
Start the engine in the vehicle that has the booster
battery, let the engine idle a few minutes, and then
start the engine in the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
Once the engine is started, remove the jumper cables
in the reverse sequence:
6
236 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
Disconnecting The Jumper Cables
1. Disconnect the negative (-) jumper cable from the
engine (-) ground of the vehicle with the discharged
battery.
2. Disconnect the negative end (-) of the jumper cable
from the negative (-) post of the booster battery.
3. Disconnect the opposite end of the positive (+) jumper
cable from the positive (+) post of the booster battery.
CAUTION!
Accessories plugged into the vehicle power outlets
draw power from the vehicle’s battery, even when not
in use (i.e., cellular phones, etc.). Eventually, if
plugged in long enough without engine operation,
the vehicle’s battery will discharge sufficiently to
degrade battery life and/or prevent the engine from
starting.
4. Disconnect the positive (+) end of the jumper cable FREEING A STUCK VEHICLE
from the positive (+) post of the vehicle with the
If your vehicle becomes stuck in mud, sand, or snow, it
discharged battery.
can often be moved using a rocking motion. Turn the
If frequent jump-starting is required to start your vehicle steering wheel right and left to clear the area around the
you should have the battery and charging system in- front wheels. Then shift back and forth between DRIVE
spected at your authorized dealer.
and REVERSE while gently pressing the accelerator
pedal. Use the least amount of accelerator pedal pressure
that will maintain the rocking motion, without spinning
the wheels or racing the engine.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 237
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Racing the engine or spinning the wheels may lead to
transmission overheating and failure. Allow the engine to idle with the transmission in NEUTRAL for at
least one minute after every five rocking-motion
cycles. This will minimize overheating and reduce
the risk of transmission failure during prolonged
efforts to free a stuck vehicle.
• When “rocking” a stuck vehicle by shifting between DRIVE and REVERSE, do not spin the
wheels faster than 15 mph (24 km/h), or drivetrain
damage may result.
• Revving the engine or spinning the wheels too fast
may lead to transmission overheating and failure.
It can also damage the tires. Do not spin the wheels
above 30 mph (48 km/h) while in gear (no transmission shifting occurring).
NOTE: To turn the ESC off, move the selector from the
Normal position to the Dynamic position and hold it for
a few moments. The Race configuration will be set when
the graph of the longitudinal and transversal G accelerations is shown in the instrument panel. At this time the
ESC has been turned off. Once the vehicle has been freed,
The selector may be moved back to the desired mode.
6
238 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
WARNING!
Fast spinning tires can be dangerous. Forces generated by excessive wheel speeds may cause damage, or
even failure, of the axle and tires. A tire could
explode and injure someone. Do not spin your vehicle’s wheels faster than 30 mph (48 km/h) or for
longer than 30 seconds continuously without stopping when you are stuck and do not let anyone near
a spinning wheel, no matter what the speed.
• Flash hazard lights as long as the battery has power or
until the ignition key is turned off.
• Turn on the interior lights, which remain on as long as the
battery has power or until the ignition key is removed.
• Unlock the doors automatically.
After the event occurs, when the system is active, in
addition to the message Fuel Cutoff See Handbook, a
specific soft telltale is displayed.
Carefully check the vehicle for fuel leaks in the engine
compartment and on the ground near the engine comENHANCED ACCIDENT RESPONSE SYSTEM
partment and fuel tank before resetting the system and
In the event of an impact, if the communication network starting the engine.
remains intact, and the power remains intact, depending
on the nature of the event the ORC will determine System Reset Procedure
whether to have the Enhanced Accident Response Sys- Depending on the nature of the event the left and right
tem perform the following functions:
turn signal lights, located in the instrument panel cluster,
may both be blinking and will continue to blink until the
• Cut off fuel to the engine.
ignition switch is turned to the OFF position.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 239
In order to move your vehicle to the side of the road you
must follow the system reset procedure.
Customer Action
1. Turn ignition OFF.
(Turn Signal Switch Must
be placed in Neutral
State).
2. Turn ignition ON.
3. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
4. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
Customer Will See
—
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
BLINKS.
Customer Action
5. Turn Right Turn Signal
Switch ON.
6. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch ON.
7. Turn Left Turn Signal
Switch OFF. (Turn Signal
Switch Must be placed in
Neutral State).
8. Turn ignition OFF.
9. Turn ignition ON.
Customer Will See
Right Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Left Turn Light
BLINKS.
Left Turn Light is ON
SOLID. Right Turn Light
is ON SOLID.
Left Turn Light is OFF.
Right Turn Light is OFF.
System is now reset and
the engine may be
started.
—
Turn Hazard Flashers OFF (Manually).
6
240 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
If a reset procedure step is not completed within 60
seconds, then the turn signal lights will turn off and the
reset procedure must be performed again in order to be
successful.
FRONT TOW EYE USAGE
Your vehicle is equipped with a tow eye that can be used
to tow a disabled vehicle.
The front tow eye receptacle is located on the lower right
side of the front fascia.
To install the tow eye, remove the rubber plug and thread
the tow eye into the receptacle.
Front Tow Eye Installed
When using a tow eye be sure to follow the “Tow Eye
NOTE: The front tow eye is found stored inside the Tire Usage Precautions” in this section.
Service Kit storage bag.
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 241
• Do not use the tow eye to pull the vehicle onto a
flatbed truck.
• Do not use the tow eye to free a stuck vehicle. Refer to
“Freeing A Stuck Vehicle” in this section for further
information.
WARNING!
Tow Eye
Tow Eye Usage Precautions
NOTE:
• Ensure that the tow eye is properly seated and secure
in the mounting receptacle.
• The tow eye is recommended for use with an approved
tow bar and or rope.
Stand clear of vehicles when pulling with tow eyes.
• Do not use a chain with a tow eye. Chains may
break, causing serious injury or death.
• Do not use a tow strap with a tow eye. Tow straps
may break or become disengaged, causing serious
injury or death.
• Failure to follow proper tow eye usage may cause
components to break resulting in serious injury or
death.
6
242 WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES
CAUTION! (Continued)
code (a rigid bar or rope) to flat tow the vehicle for
a short distance to the nearest service location.
• Tow eyes MUST NOT be used to tow vehicles off
the road or where there are obstacles.
• In compliance with the above conditions, towing
with a tow eye must take place with two vehicles
(one towing, the other towed) aligned as much as
possible along the same center line. Damage to
your vehicle may occur if these guidelines are not
followed.
Tow Eye Warning Label
CAUTION!
• The tow eye must be used exclusively for roadside
assistance operations. Only use the tow eye with an
appropriate device in accordance with the highway
(Continued)
WHAT TO DO IN EMERGENCIES 243
FIRE EXTINGUISHER — IF EQUIPPED
The fire extinguisher is located under the dashboard in
front of the passenger side seat.
6
Fire Extinguisher
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CONTENTS
䡵 ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.750 TURBO . . .247
▫ Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
䡵 ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II . .248
▫ Body Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
䡵 REPLACEMENT PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
▫ Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
䡵 DEALER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
▫ Windshield Washer Nozzles . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
䡵 MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES . . . . . . . . . . .249
▫ Adding Washer Solvent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
▫ Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
▫ Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .263
▫ Engine Oil Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
▫ Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
▫ Engine Air Cleaner Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
▫ Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
▫ Engine Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .253
▫ Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission . . . . . . . . . . .275
▫ Maintenance-Free Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
7
246 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
▫ Appearance Care And Protection From
Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
䡵 FUSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .284
▫ Engine Compartment Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . .285
▫ Dashboard Fuse Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .288
䡵 VEHICLE STORAGE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
䡵 REPLACEMENT BULBS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
䡵 BULB REPLACEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
▫ Tail Lights/Brake Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
▫ Reversing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .298
▫ Third Brake Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .299
▫ License Plate Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .300
▫ Roof Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .301
▫ Luggage Compartment Roof Light . . . . . . . . .302
䡵 FLUID CAPACITIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
▫ Front Light Clusters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
䡵 FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE
PARTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
▫ Front Side Marker . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .296
▫ Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
▫ Rear Light Clusters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
▫ Chassis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
▫ Direction Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .297
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 247
ENGINE COMPARTMENT — 1.750 TURBO
7
1 — Fuse Box
2 — Battery
3 — Engine Oil Dip Stick
4 — Engine Oil Fill
5 — Coolant Reservoir
248 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
ONBOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEM — OBD II
Your vehicle is equipped with a sophisticated onboard
diagnostic system called OBD II. This system monitors
the performance of the emissions, engine, and Alfa Twin
Clutch Transmission control systems. When these systems are operating properly, your vehicle will provide
excellent performance and fuel economy, as well as
engine emissions well within current government regulations.
If any of these systems require service, the OBD II system
will turn on the “Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL).” It
will also store diagnostic codes and other information to
assist your service technician in making repairs. Although your vehicle will usually be drivable and not
need towing, see your authorized dealer for service as
soon as possible.
CAUTION!
• Prolonged driving with the MIL on could cause
further damage to the emission control system. It
could also affect fuel economy and driveability.
The vehicle must be serviced before any emissions
tests can be performed.
• If the MIL is flashing while the engine is running,
severe catalytic converter damage and power loss
will soon occur. Immediate service is required.
REPLACEMENT PARTS
Use of genuine parts for normal/scheduled maintenance
and repairs is highly recommended to ensure the designed performance. Damage or failures caused by the
use of parts which are not quality-equivalent to genuine
parts for maintenance and repairs will not be covered by
the manufacturer’s warranty.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 249
DEALER SERVICE
MAINTENANCE PROCEDURES
Your authorized dealer has the qualified service personnel, special tools, and equipment to perform all service
operations in an expert manner. Service Manuals are
available which include detailed service information for
your vehicle. Refer to these Service Manuals before
attempting any procedure yourself.
The pages that follow contain the required maintenance
services determined by the engineers who designed your
vehicle.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems may void your warranty and could result in civil
penalties being assessed against you.
WARNING!
You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Only do service work for which you
have the knowledge and the proper equipment. If you
have any doubt about your ability to perform a service
job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
Besides those maintenance items specified in the fixed
maintenance schedule, there are other components which
may require servicing or replacement in the future.
CAUTION!
• Failure to properly maintain your vehicle or perform repairs and service when necessary could
result in more costly repairs, damage to other
components or negatively impact vehicle performance. Immediately have potential malfunctions
examined by an authorized dealer or qualified
repair center.
(Continued)
7
250 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Your vehicle has been built with improved fluids
that protect the performance and durability of your
vehicle and also allow extended maintenance intervals. Do not use chemical flushes in these components as the chemicals can damage your engine,
transmission, or air conditioning. Such damage is
not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
If a flush is needed because of component malfunction, use only the specified fluid for the flushing
procedure.
Engine Oil
Checking Oil Level
To assure proper engine lubrication, the engine oil must
be maintained at the correct level. Check the oil level at
regular intervals. The best time to check the engine oil
level is before starting the engine after it has sat overnight.
Do not check oil level when the engine is warm. Checking engine oil level when the engine is warm will give
you an incorrect reading.
Checking the oil while the vehicle is on level ground, and
has sat overnight, will improve the accuracy of the oil
level readings. Maintain the oil level between the range
markings on the dipstick. The safe range is indicated by
a crosshatch zone. Adding 1 quart of oil when the reading
is at the low end of the indicated range will result in the
oil level at the full end of the indicator range.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 251
CAUTION!
Do not overfill the engine with oil. Overfilling the
engine with oil will cause oil aeration, which can
lead to loss of oil pressure and an increase in oil
temperature. This loss of oil pressure and increased
oil temperature could damage your engine.
Engine Oil Selection
For best performance and maximum protection for turbocharged engines under all types of operating conditions, the manufacturer recommends synthetic engine
oils that are API Certified and meet the requirements of
Chrysler Material Standard MS-12991.
Engine Oil Viscosity — 1.750 Turbo Engine (SAE
Grade)
The oil change indicator system will remind you that it is SAE 5W-40 full synthetic engine oil is recommended for
time to take your vehicle in for scheduled maintenance. all operating temperatures. This engine oil improves low
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for further informa- temperature starting and vehicle fuel economy.
tion.
Lubricants which do not have both the engine oil certiNOTE: The actual interval for changing the oil and fication mark and the correct SAE viscosity grade numreplacing the engine oil filter depends on the vehicle ber should not be used.
usage conditions and is signalled by the warning light or The engine oil filler cap also shows the recommended engine
message (if present) on the instrument panel or every 12 oil viscosity for your engine. For information on engine oil
filler cap location, refer to “Engine Compartment” in “Mainmonths.
taining Your Vehicle” for further information.
Change Engine Oil
7
252 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Materials Added To Engine Oil
Engine Oil Filter
The manufacturer strongly recommends against the addition of any additives (other than leak detection dyes) to
the engine oil. Engine oil is an engineered product and its
performance may be impaired by supplemental additives.
The engine oil filter should be replaced with a new filter
at every engine oil change.
Engine Oil Filter Selection
This manufacturer’s engines have a full-flow type disposable oil filter. Use a filter of this type for replacement. The
Disposing Of Used Engine Oil And Oil Filters
quality of replacement filters varies considerably. Only
Care should be taken in disposing of used engine oil and high quality filters should be used to assure most efficient
oil filters from your vehicle. Used oil and oil filters, service. MOPAR® engine oil filters are high quality oil
indiscriminately discarded, can present a problem to the filters and are recommended.
environment. Contact your authorized dealer, service
Engine Air Cleaner Filter
station or governmental agency for advice on how and
where used oil and oil filters can be safely discarded in Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
maintenance intervals.
your area.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 253
WARNING!
The air induction system (air cleaner, hoses, etc.) can
provide a measure of protection in the case of engine
backfire. Do not remove the air induction system (air
cleaner, hoses, etc.) unless such removal is necessary
for repair or maintenance. Make sure that no one is
near the engine compartment before starting the
vehicle with the air induction system (air cleaner,
hoses, etc.) removed. Failure to do so can result in
serious personal injury.
Engine Air Cleaner Filter Selection
Engine Cover
To avoid possible damage to the engine cover, please
disconnect each of the four mounting studs by pulling
the engine cover upward, and then lift off the complete
cover. Tilting the engine cover when one or more studs
are still engaged will lead to premature failure of the
couplers.
To reassemble the cover back onto the engine, first make
sure it is properly aligned, the oil cap is centered, and that
all four studs are lined up with their couplers. Then
gently push on the four corners of the engine cover to
snap the stud back into position.
The quality of replacement engine air cleaner filters No tools are required to remove or reassemble the engine
varies considerably. Only high quality filters should be cover.
used to assure most efficient service. MOPAR® engine air
cleaner filters are a high quality filter and are recommended.
7
254 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Maintenance-Free Battery
WARNING! (Continued)
Your vehicle is equipped with a maintenance-free battery.
You will never have to add water, nor is periodic maintenance required.
WARNING!
• Battery fluid is a corrosive acid solution and can
burn or even blind you. Do not allow battery fluid
to contact your eyes, skin, or clothing. Do not lean
over a battery when attaching clamps. If acid
splashes in eyes or on skin, flush the area immediately with large amounts of water. Refer to
“Jump-Starting Procedures” in “What To Do In
Emergencies” for further information.
• Battery gas is flammable and explosive. Keep
flame or sparks away from the battery. Do not use
a booster battery or any other booster source with
(Continued)
an output greater than 12 Volts. Do not allow cable
clamps to touch each other.
• Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands
after handling.
• The battery in this vehicle has a vent hose that
should not be disconnected and should only be
replaced with a battery of the same type (vented).
CAUTION!
• It is essential when replacing the cables on the
battery that the positive cable is attached to the
positive post and the negative cable is attached to
the negative post. Battery posts are marked positive
(+) and negative (-) and are identified on the
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 255
CAUTION! (Continued)
battery case. Cable clamps should be tight on the
terminal posts and free of corrosion.
• If a “fast charger” is used while the battery is in the
vehicle, disconnect both vehicle battery cables before connecting the charger to the battery. Do not
use a “fast charger” to provide starting voltage.
Air Conditioner Maintenance
NOTE:
• Use only refrigerants and compressor lubricants approved by the manufacturer for your air conditioning
system. Some unapproved refrigerants are flammable
and can explode, injuring you. Other unapproved
refrigerants or lubricants can cause the system to fail,
requiring costly repairs. Refer to Warranty Information
Book, located on the USB card, for further warranty
information.
For best possible performance, your air conditioner • The air conditioning system contains refrigerant under
should be checked and serviced by an authorized dealer
high pressure. To avoid risk of personal injury or
at the start of each warm season. This service should
damage to the system, adding refrigerant or any repair
include cleaning of the condenser fins and a performance
requiring lines to be disconnected should be done by
test. Drive belt tension should also be checked at this
an experienced technician.
time.
7
256 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
Do not use chemical flushes in your air conditioning
system as the chemicals can damage your air conditioning components. Such damage is not covered by
the New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Refrigerant Recovery And Recycling HFO 1234yf
HFO 1234yf Air Conditioning Refrigerant is a hydrofluorocarbon (HFC) that is endorsed by the Environmental Protection Agency and is an ozone-saving product
with a low GWP (Global Warming Potential). However,
the manufacturer recommends that air conditioning service be performed by authorized dealer or other service
facilities using recovery and recycling equipment.
Body Lubrication
Locks and all body pivot points, including such items as
seat tracks, door hinge pivot points and rollers, liftgate,
tailgate, decklid, sliding doors and hood hinges, should
be lubricated periodically with a lithium based grease,
such as MOPAR® Spray White Lube to assure quiet, easy
operation and to protect against rust and wear. Prior to
the application of any lubricant, the parts concerned
should be wiped clean to remove dust and grit; after
lubricating excess oil and grease should be removed.
Particular attention should also be given to hood latching
components to ensure proper function. When performing
other underhood services, the hood latch, release mechanism and safety catch should be cleaned and lubricated.
The external lock cylinders should be lubricated twice a
NOTE: Use only manufacturer approved A/C system year, preferably in the Fall and Spring. Apply a small
PAG compressor oil, and refrigerants.
amount of a high quality lubricant, such as MOPAR®
Lock Cylinder Lubricant directly into the lock cylinder.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 257
NOTE: Life expectancy of wiper blades varies depending
on geographical area and frequency of use. Poor perforClean the rubber edges of the wiper blades and the
mance of blades may be present with chattering, marks,
windshield and rear window periodically with a sponge
water lines or wet spots. If any of these conditions are
or soft cloth and a mild nonabrasive cleaner. This will
present, clean the wiper blades or replace as necessary.
remove accumulations of salt, waxes, or road film, and
help reduce streaking and smearing.
Blade Lifting
Wiper Blades
Operation of the wipers on dry glass for long periods If it is necessary to lift the blade from the windshield (In
may cause deterioration of the wiper blades. Always use the event of snow or blade replacement) Proceed as
washer fluid when using the wipers to remove salt or dirt directed:
from a dry windshield or rear window.
1. Rotate the end of the multifunction lever to the OFF
Avoid using the wiper blades to remove frost or ice from
position.
the windshield or rear window. Make sure that they are
not frozen to the glass before turning them on to avoid 2. Turn the ignition to the MAR-ON position then to
STOP.
damaging the blade. Keep the blade rubber out of contact
with petroleum products such as engine oil, gasoline, etc.
7
258 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: The previous operation can be repeated up to
three times. In order to move the blades to the most
suitable position.
4. Lift the blade from the windshield and proceed with
the required operation.
5. Carefully lower the blade, bringing it back in contact
with the windshield.
6. Bring the blade to the initial rest position, turning the
ignition to MAR-ON.
Windshield Wiper/Washer Lever
NOTE: Do not operate the screen wiper with the blades
lifted from the windshield.
3. After turning the ignition to the STOP, within two
Front Wiper Blade Removal/Installation
minutes move the right stalk upward, into the unstable (“anti-panic”) position, for at least half of a 1. Lift the front wiper arm upward to raise the wiper
second. The windshield wiper then executes part of a
blade off of the windshield.
stroke; at each command, approximately 1/3 of a
2. Press the release button on the arm of the wiper blade.
normal wiper stroke is triggered.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 259
3. Push the wiper blade up the and remove it.
Windshield Washer Nozzles
The windshield washer nozzles are adjustable. They
originally adjusted at the factory. Should it be necessary
to adjust them again, contact your authorized Alfa Romeo Dealer.
If there is not jet of fluid, first check that there is fluid in
the washer reservoir. Refer to “Adding Washer Solvent”
in this section for further information.
Then check that the nozzle holes are not clogged; use a
suitable tool such as a needle to unblock them if necessary.
1 — Wiper Blade
2 — Release Button
3 — Wiper Arm
4. Install the wiper blade and firmly press the wiper
blade until it snaps into place.
7
260 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Adding Washer Solvent
1. To avoid any interference during the procedure, lift
the windshield wiper blade.
2. Loosen the four screws using the supplied screwdriver. Remove the washer solvent protection panel.
1 — Brake Fluid Protection Panel
2 — Washer Solvent Protection Panel
To check the windshield washer solvent level, proceed as 1 — Screw Locations
follows:
3. Release the plug from the opening.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 261
4. Leaving the plug close to the opening, put a finger on
the central hole in the plug and remove it: the level can
be seen on the control pipe due to capillarity.
7
Washer Solvent Dip Stick
5. After the check, reinsert the plug with the control pipe
in the initial position.
Washer Solvent Plug
6. Reposition the washer solvent protection panel and
tighten the four self-tapping screws.
262 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
If the level is not sufficient, namely if there is no washer
solvent inside the pipe, proceed as follows:
1. To avoid any interference during the procedure, lift
the windshield wiper blade.
2. Loosen the four screws using the supplied screwdriver. Remove the washer solvent protection panel.
3. Take the black funnel for topping up the windshield
washer solvent and its extension pipe from the service
kit in the luggage compartment.
4. Take out the plug with the solvent control pipe
through the washer solvent protection panel.
Washer Solvent Fill Funnel
6. After topping up, remove the funnel with the exten5. Introduce the funnel and its extension pipe in the
sion pipe.
reservoir neck and top up.
7. Refit the plug with the dipstick.
8. Reposition the washer solvent protection panel and
tighten the four self-tapping screws.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 263
WARNING!
Commercially available windshield washer solvents
are flammable. They could ignite and burn you. Care
must be exercised when filling or working around
the washer solution.
Exhaust System
The best protection against carbon monoxide entry into
the vehicle body is a properly maintained engine exhaust
system.
If you notice a change in the sound of the exhaust system;
or if the exhaust fumes can be detected inside the vehicle;
or when the underside or rear of the vehicle is damaged;
have an authorized technician inspect the complete exhaust system and adjacent body areas for broken, damaged, deteriorated, or mispositioned parts. Open seams
or loose connections could permit exhaust fumes to seep
into the passenger compartment. In addition, have the
exhaust system inspected each time the vehicle is raised
for lubrication or oil change. Replace as required.
WARNING!
• Exhaust gases can injure or kill. They contain
carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and
odorless. Breathing it can make you unconscious
and can eventually poison you. To avoid breathing
CO, refer to “Safety Tips/Exhaust Gas” in “Things
To Know Before Starting Your Vehicle” for further
information.
• A hot exhaust system can start a fire if you park
over materials that can burn. Such materials might
be grass or leaves coming into contact with your
exhaust system. Do not park or operate your vehicle in areas where your exhaust system can contact anything that can burn.
7
264 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
• The catalytic converter requires the use of unleaded fuel only. Leaded gasoline will destroy the
effectiveness of the catalyst as an emissions control
device and may seriously reduce engine performance and cause serious damage to the engine.
• Damage to the catalytic converter can result if your
vehicle is not kept in proper operating condition.
In the event of engine malfunction, particularly
involving engine misfire or other apparent loss of
performance, have your vehicle serviced promptly.
Continued operation of your vehicle with a severe
malfunction could cause the converter to overheat,
resulting in possible damage to the converter and
vehicle.
Under normal operating conditions, the catalytic converter will not require maintenance. However, it is important to keep the engine properly tuned to assure
proper catalyst operation and prevent possible catalyst
damage.
NOTE: Intentional tampering with emissions control
systems can result in civil penalties being assessed
against you.
In unusual situations involving grossly malfunctioning
engine operation, a scorching odor may suggest severe
and abnormal catalyst overheating. If this occurs, stop
the vehicle, turn off the engine and allow it to cool.
Service, including a tune-up to manufacturer’s specifications, should be obtained immediately.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 265
To minimize the possibility of catalytic converter dam- Cooling System
age:
• Do not shut off the engine or interrupt the ignition,
when the transmission is in gear and the vehicle is in
motion.
• Do not try to start the engine by pushing or towing the
vehicle.
• Do not idle the engine with any spark plug wires
disconnected or removed, such as when diagnostic
testing, or for prolonged periods during very rough
idle or malfunctioning operating conditions.
WARNING!
• When working near the radiator cooling fan, disconnect the fan motor lead or turn the ignition
switch to the OFF position. The fan is temperature
controlled and can start at any time the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
• You or others can be badly burned by hot engine
coolant (antifreeze) or steam from your radiator. If
you see or hear steam coming from under the hood,
do not open the hood until the radiator has had
time to cool. Never try to open a cooling system
pressure cap when the radiator is hot.
7
266 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or contains
visible sediment, have an authorized dealer clean and
Check engine coolant (antifreeze) protection every 12
flush with OAT coolant (antifreeze) (conforming to
months (before the onset of freezing weather, where
MS.90032).
applicable). If the engine coolant (antifreeze) is dirty or
rusty in appearance, the system should be drained, Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
flushed and refilled with fresh engine coolant (anti- maintenance intervals.
freeze). Check the front of the A/C condenser for any
Selection Of Coolant
accumulation of bugs, leaves, etc. If dirty, clean by gently
spraying water from a garden hose vertically down the Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in
“Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
face of the condenser.
Coolant Checks
Cooling System — Drain, Flush And Refill
NOTE: Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could lead
to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
needed to be added to the system please contact your
local authorized dealer.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 267
CAUTION!
CAUTION! (Continued)
• Mixing of engine coolant (antifreeze) other than
specified Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze), may result in engine
damage and may decrease corrosion protection.
Organic Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant is different and should not be mixed with
Hybrid Organic Additive Technology (HOAT) engine coolant (antifreeze) or any “globally compatible” coolant (antifreeze). If a non-OAT engine
coolant (antifreeze) is introduced into the cooling
system in an emergency, the cooling system will
need to be drained, flushed, and refilled with fresh
OAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032), by an authorized dealer as soon as possible.
• Do not use water alone or alcohol-based engine
coolant (antifreeze) products. Do not use additional
rust inhibitors or antirust products, as they may not
be compatible with the radiator engine coolant and
may plug the radiator.
• This vehicle has not been designed for use with
propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze).
Use of propylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is not recommended.
(Continued)
Adding Coolant
Your vehicle has been built with an improved engine
coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS.90032) that allows extended maintenance intervals. This engine coolant (antifreeze) can be used up to ten years or 150,000
miles (240,000 km) before replacement. To prevent reducing this extended maintenance period, it is important that
you use the same engine coolant (OAT coolant conforming to MS.90032) throughout the life of your vehicle.
7
268 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Please review these recommendations for using Organic
Additive Technology (OAT) engine coolant (antifreeze)
that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS.90032. When adding engine coolant (antifreeze):
Please note that it is the owner’s responsibility to maintain the proper level of protection against freezing according to the temperatures occurring in the area where
the vehicle is operated.
• We recommend using MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant NOTE:
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive
• Some vehicles require special tools to add coolant
Technology) that meets the requirements of Chrysler
properly. Failure to fill these systems properly could
Material Standard MS.90032.
lead to severe internal engine damage. If any coolant is
needed to be added to the system please contact your
• Mix a minimum solution of 50% OAT engine coolant
local authorized dealer.
that meets the requirements of Chrysler Material Standard MS.90032 and distilled water. Use higher concen• Mixing engine coolant (antifreeze) types is not recomtrations (not to exceed 70%) if temperatures below
mended and can result in cooling system damage. If
−34° F (−37° C) are anticipated.
HOAT and OAT coolant are mixed in an emergency,
have a authorized dealer drain, flush, and refill with
• Use only high purity water such as distilled or deionOAT coolant (conforming to MS.90032) as soon as
ized water when mixing the water/engine coolant
possible.
(antifreeze) solution. The use of lower quality water
will reduce the amount of corrosion protection in the
engine cooling system.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 269
Cooling System Pressure Cap
WARNING! (Continued)
The cap must be fully tightened to prevent loss of engine
coolant (antifreeze) and to ensure that engine coolant
(antifreeze) will return to the radiator from the coolant
recovery tank.
• Do not use a pressure cap other than the one
specified for your vehicle. Personal injury or engine damage may result.
The cap should be inspected and cleaned if there is any Disposal Of Used Engine Coolant
accumulation of foreign material on the sealing surfaces. Used ethylene glycol-based engine coolant (antifreeze) is
a regulated substance requiring proper disposal. Check
with your local authorities to determine the disposal
WARNING!
rules for your community. To prevent ingestion by ani• Do not open hot engine cooling system. Never add mals or children, do not store ethylene glycol-based
engine coolant (antifreeze) when the engine is engine coolant in open containers or allow it to remain in
overheated. Do not loosen or remove the cap to cool puddles on the ground. If ingested by a child or pet, seek
an overheated engine. Heat causes pressure to emergency assistance immediately. Clean up any ground
build up in the cooling system. To prevent scalding spills immediately.
or injury, do not remove the pressure cap while the
system is hot or under pressure.
(Continued)
7
270 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Coolant Level
The coolant expansion bottle provides a quick
method for determining that the coolant level
equate. With the engine off and cold, the level
engine coolant (antifreeze) in the bottle should
tween the “MIN” and “MAX” marks.
Points To Remember
visual
is adof the
be be-
NOTE: When the vehicle is stopped after a few miles/
kilometers of operation, you may observe vapor coming
from the front of the engine compartment. This is normally a result of moisture from rain, snow, or high
humidity accumulating on the radiator and being vaporized when the thermostat opens, allowing hot engine
As long as the engine operating temperature is satisfactory, the coolant bottle need only be checked once a coolant (antifreeze) to enter the radiator.
month.
If an examination of your engine compartment shows no
evidence of radiator or hose leaks, the vehicle may be
When additional engine coolant (antifreeze) is needed to
safely driven. The vapor will soon dissipate.
maintain the proper level, it should be added to the
• Do not overfill the coolant expansion bottle.
coolant bottle. Do not overfill.
• Check the coolant freeze point in the radiator and in
the coolant expansion bottle. If engine coolant (antifreeze) needs to be added, the contents of the coolant
expansion bottle must also be protected against freezing.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 271
• If frequent engine coolant (antifreeze) additions are Brake System
required, the cooling system should be pressure tested In order to assure brake system performance, all brake
for leaks.
system components should be inspected periodically.
• Maintain engine coolant (antifreeze) concentration at a Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” for the proper
minimum of 50% OAT coolant (conforming to MS- maintenance intervals.
90032) and distilled water for proper corrosion protection of your engine which contains aluminum compoWARNING!
nents.
Riding the brakes can lead to brake failure and
• Keep the front of the radiator clean. If your vehicle is possibly a collision. Driving with your foot resting or
equipped with air conditioning, keep the front of the riding on the brake pedal can result in abnormally
condenser clean.
high brake temperatures, excessive lining wear, and
• Do not change the thermostat for Summer or Winter possible brake damage. Riding the brakes may also
operation. If replacement is ever necessary, install reduce braking capacity in an emergency.
ONLY the correct type thermostat. Other designs may
result in unsatisfactory engine coolant (antifreeze) Brake Master Cylinder
performance, poor gas mileage, and increased emis- The fluid level in the master cylinder should be checked
sions.
when performing under hood services, or immediately if
the “Brake Warning Light” is on.
7
272 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Be sure to clean the top of the master cylinder area before
removing the cap. If necessary, add fluid to bring the
fluid level up to the requirements described on the brake
fluid reservoir. Fluid level can be expected to fall as the
brake pads wear. The brake fluid level should be checked
when the pads are replaced. However, low fluid level
may be caused by a leak and a checkup may be needed.
Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information.
WARNING!
• Use only manufacturer’s recommended brake
fluid. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine
Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further
information. Using the wrong type of brake fluid
can severely damage your brake system and/or
(Continued)
WARNING! (Continued)
impair its performance. The proper type of brake
fluid for your vehicle is also identified on the
original factory installed hydraulic master cylinder
reservoir.
• To avoid contamination from foreign matter or
moisture, use only new brake fluid or fluid that has
been in a tightly closed container. Keep the master
cylinder reservoir cap secured at all times. Brake
fluid in a open container absorbs moisture from the
air resulting in a lower boiling point. This may
cause it to boil unexpectedly during hard or prolonged braking, resulting in sudden brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
• Overfilling the brake fluid reservoir can result in
spilling brake fluid on hot engine parts, causing
the brake fluid to catch fire. Brake fluid can also
(Continued)
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 273
WARNING! (Continued)
Checking Brake Fluid
damage painted and vinyl surfaces, care should be
taken to avoid its contact with these surfaces.
• Do not allow petroleum-based fluid to contaminate
the brake fluid. Brake seal components could be
damaged, causing partial or complete brake failure.
This could result in a collision.
CAUTION!
Use of improper brake fluids will affect overall
clutch system performance. Improper brake fluids
may damage the clutch system resulting in loss of
clutch function and the ability to shift the transmission.
7
1 — Brake Fluid Protection Panel
2 — Washer Solvent Protection Panel
274 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
To check the brake fluid level, proceed as follows:
2. Check that the fluid is at the max. level.
1. Loosen the two screws and remove the brake fluid 3. After checking, reposition the brake fluid protection
protection panel.
panel and tighten the two screws.
Adding Brake Fluid
If the fluid level in the reservoir is not sufficient, proceed
as follows:
1. Take the black funnel for topping up the brake fluid
and its extension pipe from the service kit in the
luggage compartment.
2. Loosen the reservoir plug and introduce the funnel
with the extension pipe in the reservoir inlet.
Brake Fluid Protection Panel
1 — Screw Locations
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 275
NOTE: Be very careful while removing the plug from the
opening to prevent the plug from falling inside the
vehicle body.
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission
Selection Of Lubricant
It is important to use the proper transmission fluid to
ensure optimum transmission performance and life. Use
only the manufacturer’s specified transmission fluid.
Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in this
section for fluid specifications. It is important to maintain
the transmission fluid at the correct level using the
Brake Fluid Funnel
recommended fluid. No chemical flushes should be used
3. After topping up, remove the funnel with the extenin any transmission; only the approved lubricant should
sion pipe.
be used.
4. Tighten the reservoir plug.
5. Reposition the brake fluid protection panel and
tighten the two screws.
7
276 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
CAUTION!
CAUTION!
Using a transmission fluid other than the manufacturer’s recommended fluid may cause deterioration
in transmission shift quality. Refer to “Fluids, Lubricants, and Genuine Parts” in this section for fluid
specifications.
Do not use chemical flushes in your transmission as
the chemicals can damage your transmission components. Such damage is not covered by the New
Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Special Additives
Fluid Level Check
The fluid level is preset at the factory and does not
The manufacturer strongly recommends against using require adjustment under normal operating conditions.
any special additives in the transmission.
Routine fluid level checks are not required, therefore the
transmission has no dipstick. Your authorized dealer can
Transmission fluid is an engineered product and its
check your transmission fluid level using special service
performance may be impaired by supplemental additools. If you notice fluid leakage or transmission malfunctives. Therefore, do not add any fluid additives to the
tion, visit your authorized dealer immediately to have
transmission. The only exception to this policy is the use
the transmission fluid level checked. Operating the veof special dyes for diagnosing fluid leaks.
hicle with an improper fluid level can cause severe
transmission damage.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 277
CAUTION!
If a transmission fluid leak occurs, visit your authorized dealer immediately. Severe transmission damage may occur. Your authorized dealer has the proper
tools to adjust the fluid level accurately.
Fluid Changes
Under normal operating conditions, the fluid installed at
the factory will provide satisfactory lubrication for the
life of the vehicle. However, change the fluid if it becomes
contaminated (with water, etc.), or if the transmission is
disassembled for any reason.
trees and road surfaces during other seasons are highly
corrosive to the metal in your vehicle. Outside parking,
which exposes your vehicle to airborne contaminants,
road surfaces on which the vehicle is operated, extreme
hot or cold weather and other extreme conditions will
have an adverse effect on paint, metal trim, and underbody protection.
The following maintenance recommendations will enable
you to obtain maximum benefit from the corrosion
resistance built into your vehicle.
What Causes Corrosion?
Appearance Care And Protection From Corrosion
Corrosion is the result of deterioration or removal of
paint and protective coatings from your vehicle.
Protection Of Body And Paint From Corrosion
The most common causes are:
• Road salt, dirt and moisture accumulation.
Vehicle body care requirements vary according to geographic locations and usage. Chemicals that make roads • Stone and gravel impact.
passable in snow and ice and those that are sprayed on
7
278 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
• Insects, tree sap and tar.
• Salt in the air near seacoast localities.
• Atmospheric fallout/industrial pollutants.
Washing
• Wash your vehicle regularly. Always wash your vehicle in the shade using MOPAR® Car Wash, or a mild
car wash soap, and rinse the panels completely with
clear water.
• If insects, tar, or other similar deposits have accumulated on your vehicle, use MOPAR® Super Kleen Bug
and Tar Remover to remove.
• Use a high quality cleaner wax, such as MOPAR®
Cleaner Wax to remove road film, stains and to protect
your paint finish. Take care never to scratch the paint.
• Avoid using abrasive compounds and power buffing
that may diminish the gloss or thin out the paint finish.
NOTE: Hand washing is recommended. Avoid washing
with power washers, or commercial car wash facilities.
CAUTION!
• Do not use abrasive or strong cleaning materials
such as steel wool or scouring powder that will
scratch metal and painted surfaces.
• Use of power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274
kPa) can result in damage or removal of paint and
decals.
• If the engine compartment is washed with an high
pressure jet, keep it at a distance of at least 8 inches
(20 centimeters) from filler surface.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 279
• If you carry special cargo such as chemicals, fertilizers,
de-icer salt, etc., be sure that such materials are well
• If you drive on salted or dusty roads or if you drive
packaged and sealed.
near the ocean, hose off the undercarriage at least once
a month.
• If a lot of driving is done on gravel roads, consider
mud or stone shields behind each wheel.
• It is important that the drain holes in the lower edges
of the doors, rocker panels, and trunk be kept clear and • Use MOPAR® Touch Up Paint on scratches as soon as
open.
possible. Your authorized dealer has touch up paint to
match the color of your vehicle.
• If you detect any stone chips or scratches in the paint,
Special Care
touch them up immediately. The cost of such repairs is Wheel And Wheel Trim Care
considered the responsibility of the owner.
• All wheels and wheel trim, especially aluminum and
• If your vehicle is damaged due to a collision or similar
chrome plated wheels, should be cleaned regularly
cause that destroys the paint and protective coating,
with a mild soap and water to prevent corrosion.
have your vehicle repaired as soon as possible. The
cost of such repairs is considered the responsibility of • To remove heavy soil and/or excessive brake dust, use
MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner.
the owner.
7
280 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
NOTE: If your vehicle is equipped with Dark Vapor or
Black Satin Chrome wheels DO NOT USE wheel cleaners,
abrasives or polishing compounds. They will permanently damage this finish and such damage is not covered by the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. USE ONLY
MILD SOAP AND WATER WITH A SOFT CLOTH. Used
on a regular basis this is all that is required to maintain
this finish.
CAUTION!
Do not use scouring pads, steel wool, a bristle brush,
or metal polishes. Do not use oven cleaner. These
products may damage the wheel’s protective finish.
Avoid automatic car washes that use acidic solutions
or harsh brushes that may damage the wheel’s protective finish. Only MOPAR® Wheel Cleaner or
equivalent is recommended.
Stain Repel Fabric Cleaning Procedure — If
Equipped
Stain Repel seats may be cleaned in the following manner:
• Remove as much of the stain as possible by blotting
with a clean, dry towel.
• Blot any remaining stain with a clean, damp towel.
• For tough stains, apply MOPAR® Total Clean, or a
mild soap solution to a clean, damp cloth and remove
stain. Use a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
• For grease stains, apply MOPAR® Multi-Purpose
Cleaner to a clean, damp cloth and remove stain. Use
a fresh, damp towel to remove soap residue.
• Do not use any harsh solvents or any other form of
protectants on Stain Repel products.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 281
Interior Care
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean fabric upholstery and
carpeting.
Use MOPAR® Total Clean to clean vinyl upholstery.
MOPAR® Total Clean is specifically recommended for
leather upholstery.
Your leather upholstery can be best preserved by regular
cleaning with a damp soft cloth. Small particles of dirt
can act as an abrasive and damage the leather upholstery
and should be removed promptly with a damp cloth.
Stubborn soils can be removed easily with a soft cloth
and MOPAR® Total Clean. Care should be taken to avoid
soaking your leather upholstery with any liquid. Please
do not use polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents, detergents, or ammonia-based cleaners to clean your leather
upholstery. Application of a leather conditioner is not
required to maintain the original condition.
WARNING!
Do not use volatile solvents for cleaning purposes.
Many are potentially flammable, and if used in
closed areas they may cause respiratory harm.
CAUTION!
Do not use Alcohol and Alcohol-based and/or Keton
based cleaning products to clean leather seats, as
damage to the seat may result.
Cleaning Headlights
Your vehicle has plastic headlights that are lighter and
less susceptible to stone breakage than glass headlights.
Plastic is not as scratch resistant as glass and therefore
different lens cleaning procedures must be followed.
7
282 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
To minimize the possibility of scratching the lenses and When cleaning the rear view mirror, spray cleaner on the
reducing light output, avoid wiping with a dry cloth. To towel or rag that you are using. Do not spray cleaner
remove road dirt, wash with a mild soap solution fol- directly on the mirror.
lowed by rinsing.
Instrument Panel Cover
Do not use abrasive cleaning components, solvents, steel The instrument panel cover has a low glare surface which
wool or other aggressive material to clean the lenses.
minimizes reflections on the windshield. Do not use
Glass Surfaces
protectants or other products which may cause undesirable reflections. Use soap and warm water to restore the
low glare surface.
All glass surfaces should be cleaned on a regular basis
with MOPAR®, or any commercial household-type glass
cleaner. Never use an abrasive type cleaner. Use caution Instrument Panel Bezels
when cleaning the inside rear window equipped. Do not
use scrapers or other sharp instrument that may scratch
CAUTION!
the elements.
When installing hanging air fresheners in your veLabels can be peeled off after soaking with warm water hicle, read the installation instructions carefully.
(If Equipped), keep all objects a safe distance from the Some air fresheners will damage the finish of
windows.
painted or decorated parts if allowed to directly
contact any surface.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 283
Cleaning Plastic Instrument Cluster Lenses
The lenses in front of the instruments in this vehicle are
molded in clear plastic. When cleaning the lenses, care
must be taken to avoid scratching the plastic.
1. Clean with a wet soft rag. A mild soap solution may be
used, but do not use high alcohol content or abrasive
cleaners. If soap is used, wipe clean with a clean damp
rag.
2. Dry with a soft cloth.
Seat Belt Maintenance
Do not bleach, dye or clean the belts with chemical
solvents or abrasive cleaners. This will weaken the fabric.
Sun damage can also weaken the fabric.
If the belts need cleaning, use a mild soap solution or
lukewarm water. Do not remove the belts from the car to
wash them. Dry with a soft cloth.
Replace the belts if they appear frayed or worn or if the
buckles do not work properly.
WARNING!
A frayed or torn belt could rip apart in a collision and
leave you with no protection. Inspect the belt system
periodically, checking for cuts, frays, or loose parts.
Damaged parts must be replaced immediately. Do
not disassemble or modify the system. Seat belt
assemblies must be replaced after a collision if they
have been damaged (i.e., bent retractor, torn webbing, etc.).
7
284 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FUSES
WARNING! (Continued)
WARNING!
• When replacing a blown fuse, always use an appropriate replacement fuse with the same amp
rating as the original fuse. Never replace a fuse
with another fuse of higher amp rating. Never
replace a blown fuse with metal wires or any other
material. Failure to use proper fuses may result in
serious personal injury, fire and/or property damage.
• Before replacing a fuse, make sure that the ignition
is off and that all the other services are switched off
and/or disengaged.
• If the replaced fuse blows again, contact an authorized dealer.
(Continued)
• If a general protection fuse for safety systems (air
bag system, braking system), power unit systems
(engine system, gearbox system) or steering system
blows, contact an authorized dealer.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 285
Engine Compartment Fuses
The engine compartment fuse box is located on the left
side of the engine compartment, next to the battery. To
access the fuses, remove screws and then remove the
cover.
7
Engine Compartment Fuse Box
1 — Forward Screw
2 — Fuse Box Cover
3 — Rearward Screw
The ID number of the electrical component corresponding to each fuse can be found on the back of the cover.
286 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Cavity
F01
F03
F04
F05
F06
F07
F08
F09
F10
F11
F14
F15
F16
F17
F18
Maxi Fuse
70 Amp Tan
20 Amp Yellow
40 Amp Orange
20 Amp Yellow
40 Amp Orange
50 Amp Red
20 Amp Yellow
Mini Fuse
5 Amp Tan
10 Amp Red
20 Amp Yellow
15 Amp Blue
15 Amp Blue
5 Amp Tan
10 Amp Red
5 Amp Tan
Description
Body Controller
Ignition Switch
Anti-Lock Brake Pump
Anti-Lock Brake Valve
Radiator Fan - Low Speed
Radiator Fan - High Speed
Blower Motor
Headlight beam switch (If Equipped)
Horn
Powertrain
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission, ECM
Powertrain
Powertrain
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 287
Cavity
F19
F21
F22
F24
F30
F82
F83
F84
F86
F88
Maxi Fuse
Mini Fuse
7.5 Amp Brown
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
5 Amp Tan
10 Amp Red
30 Amp Green
40 Amp Orange
5 Amp Tan
15 Amp Blue
7.5 Amp Brown
Description
Air Conditioning Compressor
Fuel Pump
Engine Control Unit Power Supply
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)
Water Pump, HVAC
Headlamp Washer (If Equipped)
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission Pump
After Run Pump
Rear Power Outlet 12V
Heated Mirrors
7
288 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Dashboard Fuse Box
The dashboard fuse box is part of the Body Control
Module (BCM) and is located on the passenger side
under the forward passenger floor. Remove the six
screws and the forward floor pan to access the BCM.
Mini Fuse
Description
3
4
5
6
7
9
10
Vehicle Fuse
Number
F53
F38
F36
F43
F48
F50
F51
7.5 Amp Brown
15 Amp Blue
10 Amp Red
20 Amp Yellow
20 Amp Yellow
7.5 Amp Brown
7.5 Amp Brown
11
F37
7.5 Amp Brown
Instrument Panel Node
Central Door Locking
Diagnostic Socket, Car Radio, TPMS, Alarm
Bi-Directional Washer
Passenger Power Window
Airbag
Headlamp Washer Relay, A/C Compressor Relay, High
Beam Relay, Parking ECU, Car Radio, Stop Lamp
Switch
Stop Light Switch, Instrument Panel Node
Cavity
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 289
12
Vehicle Fuse
Number
F49
5 Amp Tan
13
14
F31
F47
5 Amp Tan
20 Amp Yellow
Cavity
Mini Fuse
VEHICLE STORAGE
Description
Transmission Shifter Module, Cigar Lighter Light,
Drive Style Unit, Heated Mirrors Relay
Climate Control, Body Controller
Driver Power Window
ensure adequate system lubrication to minimize the
possibility of compressor damage when the system is
started again.
If you are leaving your vehicle dormant for more than 21
days, you may want to take these steps to protect your
battery.
REPLACEMENT BULBS
• Disconnect the negative cable from the battery.
• Anytime you store your vehicle, or keep it out of Interior Bulbs
service (e.g., vacation) for two weeks or more, run the
air conditioning system at idle for about five minutes
in the fresh air and high blower setting. This will
Overhead Lamp
Luggage Compartment
7
Bulb Number
C10W
W5W
290 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Exterior Bulbs
Parking Lights/Daytime
Running Lights (DRL)
Rear Tail Lights
Font and Rear Side Lights
Dipped/Main Beam Headlights (Versions With BiHalogen Headlights) — If
Equipped
Dipped/Main Beam Headlights (Versions With BiXenon Headlights) — If
Equipped
Dipped/Main Beam Headlights (Versions With Bi-Led
Bulb Number
Bulb Number
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
W3W
HIR2
D5S (See Authorized
dealer)
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
Headlights) — If Equipped
Front Direction Indicators
Rear Direction Indicators
Side Direction Indicators
Brake Lights
Third Brake Light
License Plate Lamps
Reversing light
PY24W
P21W
WY5W
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
LED (See Authorized
dealer)
W5W
W16W
NOTE: Numbers refer to commercial bulb types that
can be purchased from your authorized dealer.
If a bulb needs to be replaced, visit your authorized
dealer or refer to the applicable Service Manual.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 291
BULB REPLACEMENT
NOTE: Lens fogging can occur under certain atmospheric conditions. This will usually clear as atmospheric
conditions change to allow the condensation to change
back into a vapor. Turning the lamps on will usually
accelerate the clearing process.
Front Light Clusters
The front head lamp contains bulbs for the parking
lights/daytime running lights (DRL), low beam headlights, high beam headlights and direction indicators.
7
1 — Daytime Running Lights
2 — Direction Indicator
3 — High/Low Beam Lights
If bulb replacement is required, please see an authorized
dealer.
292 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Side Lights/Daytime Running Lights (DRL)
These are LEDs. For the replacement, contact the your
authorized dealer.
Low/High Beam Bi-Halogen Headlights
To change the bulb, proceed as follows:
1. Turn the steering wheel completely.
2. Open the protective flap by rotating the screw.
1 — Direction Indicator Bulb Protective Flap
2 — Headlamp Bulb Protective Flap
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 293
3. Remove the electric connector (1) and then rotate the 4. Extract the bulb and replace it.
bulb holder (2) clockwise and remove it.
5. Refit the new bulb, making sure that it is locked
correctly, and reconnect the electrical connector.
6. Close the protective flap.
Low/High Beam HID & LED Headlights
For the replacement, contact the your authorized dealer.
Direction Indicators
Front:
1. Turn the steering wheel completely.
2. Open the protective flap by rotating the screw.
1 — Electrical Connector
2 — Bulb Holder
7
294 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
4. Rotate the bulb assembly counter clockwise to remove
from bulb holder.
5. Install the new bulb, making sure that it is locked in
correctly, and reinstall into headlamp assembly.
1 — Direction Indicator Bulb Protective Flap
2 — Headlamp Bulb Protective Flap
3. Rotate the bulb holder counterclockwise and remove
it.
Bulb Holder
6. Close the protective flap.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 295
Side:
1. Adjust the lens in the point shown in to compress the
retaining clip, then pull the cluster outwards.
2. Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise, remove the
bulb and replace it.
3. Install the bulb holder in the lens and turn it clockwise.
4. Install the cluster making sure that the internal clip
clicks into position.
7
1 — Lens
2 — Bulb Holder
296 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Front Side Marker
2. Fold back wheel liner door to access bulb housing.
To change the bulb, proceed as follows:
1. Turn the front wheels to gain access and then remove
the fastener from the inner wheel liner.
Bulb Housing Location
Fastener Location
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 297
3. Remove bulb from bulb housing then remove and Direction Indicators
replace bulb and reinstall.
To change the bulb, proceed as follows:
1. Remove the protective cap (one for each side) on the
side cover of the luggage compartment.
7
Front Side Marker Bulb
Rear Light Clusters
These contain the bulbs for the side lights, direction
indicators and brake lights.
First Protective Cap
298 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
2. Remove the second protective cap inserting a hand 4. Install the bulb by pressing it into bulb holder then
inside the opening.
turn install the bulb holder and turn it counterclockwise.
5. Install the previously removed protective caps.
Tail Lights/Brake Lights
These are LEDs. For the replacement, contact the your
local dealer.
Reversing Light
WARNING!
Second Protective Cap
3. Rotate clockwise to remove the bulb holder remove
the bulb from the bulb holder.
The reversing light are located close to the exhaust
pipes; take the utmost care not to get burnt during
the bulb replacement.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 299
To replace the reversing lights turn the bulb holder
counterclockwise, remove the bulb and replace it.
7
Reversing Light Bulb Holder
Third Brake Lights
1 — Reverse Light Location
2 — Reverse Light Location
These are LEDs. For the replacement, contact your local
dealer.
300 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
License Plate Lights
To replace the bulbs proceed as follows:
2. Turn bulb holder (1) counterclockwise, remove bulb
(2) and replace it.
1. Position the lens in the point shown laterally to
compress the retaining clip, then pull the license plate
light cluster out.
1 — Bulb Holder
2 — Bulb
License Plate Lamp Removal
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 301
Roof Light
To change the bulb, proceed as follows:
2. Open protective flap (2) and replace bulb (1), releasing
it from the side contacts. Make sure that the new bulb
is correctly secured between the contacts.
1. Remove roof light working at the points indicated by
the arrows.
7
1 — Bulb
2 — Protective Flap
Roof Light
3. Close protective flap (2) and install roof light in its
housing, making sure that it is locked in place.
302 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
Luggage Compartment Roof Light
To replace the bulb, proceed as follows:
1. Open the luggage compartment and remove luggage
compartment roof light, working in the direction
shown by the arrow.
1 — Light Cover
2 — Light Protector
2. Open light protector (2) and replace the bulb.
3. Close protector on the lens.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 303
4. Install luggage compartment roof light by inserting it
in its correct position, first on one side and then
pressing on the other side until it clicks into place.
FLUID CAPACITIES
Fuel (Approximate)
1.750 Turbo Engine
Reserve Fuel
Engine Oil with Filter
1.750 Turbo Engine
Cooling System
1.750 Turbo Engine (MOPAR®
Antifreeze/Engine Coolant 10
Year/150,000 Mile Formula).
U.S.
Metric
10.5 Gallons
1.1 Gallons
40 Liters
4 Liters
6.1 Quarts
5.8 Liters
11.2 Quarts
10.6 Liters
7
304 MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE
FLUIDS, LUBRICANTS AND GENUINE PARTS
Engine
Component
Engine Coolant - 1.750 Turbo Engine
Engine Oil - 1.750 Turbo Engine
Engine Oil Filter - 1.750 Turbo Engine
Spark Plugs - 1.750 Turbo Engine
Fuel Selection - 1.750 Turbo Engine
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
We recommend you use MOPAR® Antifreeze/Coolant
10 Year/150,000 Mile Formula OAT (Organic Additive
Technology) or equivalent meeting the requirements of
Chrysler Material Standard MS.90032.
We recommend you use SAE 5W-40 API Certified
Synthetic Engine Oil, meeting the requirements of
Chrysler Material Standard MS-12991. Refer to your
engine oil filler cap for correct SAE grade.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Engine Oil Filter.
We recommend you use MOPAR® Spark Plugs. *
Use Only 91 Octane or higher.
MAINTAINING YOUR VEHICLE 305
NOTE: * The following are essential to ensure correct
operation and prevent serious damage to the engine: only
use spark plugs of the same make and type which are
specially certified for such engines strictly comply with
the spark plug replacement interval given in the maintenance schedule. For spark plug replacement, it is advisable to contact the dedicated Alfa Romeo Dealership.
Refer to the “Maintenance Schedule” section for the
required spark plug intervals.
Chassis
Component
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission
Brake Master Cylinder
Fluid, Lubricant, or Genuine Part
Gear Oil: Use Castrol BOT402
Control System: MOPAR® C Series DDCT SAE 75W
Hydraulic Fluid or equivalent.
We recommend you use MOPAR® DOT 4. If DOT 4
brake fluid is not available, then DOT 3 is acceptable.
7
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
CONTENTS
䡵 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
▫ Maintenance Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .311
8
308 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
The Wrench Warning Light may appear in the cluster as
a service reminder when vehicle maintenance is required,
Your vehicle is equipped with an automatic oil change
according to the scheduled maintenance mileage. The
indicator system. The oil change indicator system will
maintenance schedule intervals are set by the manufacremind you that it is time to take your vehicle in for
turer. Failure to have them carried out may void your
scheduled maintenance.
New Vehicle Warranty.
Based on engine operation conditions, the oil change
NOTE: The actual interval for changing the oil and replacindicator message will illuminate in the instrument clusing the engine oil filter depends on the vehicle usage
ter. This means that an engine oil and engine oil filter
conditions and is signalled by the warning light or message
change is required for your vehicle. Operating conditions
(if present) on the instrument panel or every 12 months.
such as frequent short-trips, trailer tow, extremely hot or
cold ambient temperatures, and E85 fuel usage will Severe Duty All Models
influence when the “Change Oil” or “Oil Change ReIn addition, if your vehicle is used under demanding
quired” message is displayed. Severe Operating Condiconditions, including:
tions can cause the change oil message to illuminate as
early as 3,500 miles (5,600 km) since last reset. Have your • On the track
vehicle serviced as soon as possible, within the next 500 • On dusty roads
miles (805 km).
• Short, repeated trips (less than 4-5 miles or 7-8 km) at
sub-zero temperatures
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 309
• Allowing the engine to idle for extended periods of • Check battery charge and battery fluid level (electrolyte)
time
• Driving for long distances at low speeds
• Visually inspect condition of the auxiliary drive belts
• Allowing the vehicle to sit for long periods of inactivity • Check and, if necessary, change engine oil and replace
oil filter
Under any of the above circumstances, the following
checks need to be performed more frequently than indi- • Check and, if necessary, replace air cleaner
cated in the Maintenance Schedule:
Using the car on track should be regarded as an excep• Check front and rear disc brake pad condition and tion. The car has been designed and produced for road
wear
use.
• Check cleanliness of tailgate locks.
Change Engine Oil at 4000 miles (6,500 km) if the vehicle
is operated in a dusty and off road environment. This
• Check cleanliness and lubrication of chassis and steertype of vehicle use is considered Severe Duty.
ing linkage
If the vehicle is operated in a dusty or dirty environment
• Visually inspect condition of: engine, gearbox, transthe engine air filter has to be changed every 6500 miles
mission, pipes and hoses (exhaust - fuel system (10,000 km).
brakes) and rubber elements (gaiters - sleeves - bushes
- etc.)
8
310 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
Once A Month Or Before A Long Trip/Periodic Checks Required Maintenance Intervals
Every 600 miles (1,000 km) or before long trips, check Refer to the maintenance schedules on the following
and, if necessary, top off the following:
page for the required maintenance intervals.
• Check engine oil level
• Check brake fluid level
• Check windshield washer fluid level
• Check the tire inflation pressures and look for unusual
wear or damage
• Check the fluid levels of the coolant reservoir and
brake master cylinder reservoir, and add as needed
• Check function of all interior and exterior lights
• Check screen wash/wipe system and positioning/
wear of windscreen
Every 2000 miles (3000 km) check and, if necessary, top
up: engine oil level
At Every Oil Change Interval As Indicated By Oil
Change Indicator System:
Change oil and filter.
Inspect battery and clean and tighten terminals as
required.
Inspect brake pads, shoes, rotors, drums, and hoses.
Inspect engine cooling system protection and hoses.
Check and adjust hand brake.
Inspect exhaust system.
Inspect engine air cleaner if using in dusty or off-road
conditions.
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 311
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
12,000
24,000
36,000
48,000
60,000
72,000
Or Months:
Or Kilometers:
12
24
36
48
60
72
20,000
40,000
60,000
80,000
100,000
120,000
Maintenance Chart
Check battery charge status and possibly recharge ⌂
Check tire condition/wear and adjust pressure if required
Check lighting system operation (headlights, direction indicators,
hazard lights, passenger compartment lights, boot lights, instrument
panel warning lights, etc.)
Check vehicle fasteners
Check mechanical components fasteners
Check windscreen wiper/washer operation, adjust nozzles
Check position/wear of windscreen wiper blade
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
8
72,000
60
72
Check cleanliness of hood and deck lid locks, as well as cleanliness and lubrication of associated linkages
Visually inspect condition of: exterior bodywork, carbon monocoque,
aerodynamic bottom, pipes and hoses (exhaust, fuel supply system,
brakes), rubber elements (boots, driveshaft boots, sleeves, bushes,
etc.)
Check condition and wear of front brake pads and discs, and operation of pad wear indicator
Check condition and wear of rear brake pads and discs, and operation of pad wear indicator
Check and top off, if required, fluid levels (engine coolant, brake/
hydraulic clutch fluid, windscreen washer fluid, battery fluid, etc)
Visually inspect the condition of accessory drive belt(s)
120,000
60,000
48
100,000
48,000
36
80,000
36,000
24
60,000
24,000
12
40,000
Or Months:
Or Kilometers:
20,000
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
12,000
312 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
36,000
48,000
60,000
72,000
24
36
48
60
72
40,000
60,000
Check condition of timing belt
Check handbrake lever travel and adjust, if necessary (or every 12
months)
Check exhaust gas emissions, or as required by applicable laws
Check engine control system operation (via diagnostic tool)
Check and, if necessary, top off oil level of dual clutch automatic
transmission
Replace accessory drive belt(s)
Replace spark plugs (#)
Replace toothed timing drive belt (*)
Change engine oil and oil filter (**)
Change brake fluid (or every 24 months)
120,000
24,000
12
100,000
12,000
Or Months:
Or Kilometers:
80,000
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
20,000
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 313
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
8
Mileage or time passed (whichever comes first)
12,000
24,000
36,000
48,000
60,000
72,000
Or Months:
Or Kilometers:
12
24
36
48
60
72
20,000
40,000
60,000
80,000
100,000
120,000
314 MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
X
X
X
X
X
X
Replace air filter cartridge (***)
(⌂) Recommend using Midtronics tester to check charge • Strictly comply with the spark plug replacement interstatus and, if necessary, recharge battery.
val given in the maintenance schedule for spark plug
replacement.
(#) The spark plug change interval is mileage based only,
yearly intervals do not apply. The following are essential • Contact your Alfa Romeo Dealer if you have questions.
to ensure correct operation and prevent serious damage
(*) Regardless of the distance covered, the timing belt
to the engine:
must be changed every 4 years for particularly demand• Only use spark plugs of the same make and type ing use (cold climates, city driving, long periods of
which are specially certified for such engines (refer to idling) or at least every 5 years.
“Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts” in “Maintaining Your Vehicle” for further information).
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES 315
(**) The actual interval for changing the oil and replacing
the engine oil filter depends on the vehicle usage conditions and is signalled by the warning light or message (if
present) on the instrument panel or every 12 months.
(***) If the vehicle is operated in a dusty or dirty
environment the engine air filter has to be changed every
6,500 miles (10,000 km).
WARNING!
• You can be badly injured working on or around a
motor vehicle. Do only service work for which you
have the knowledge and the right equipment. If
you have any doubt about your ability to perform a
service job, take your vehicle to a competent mechanic.
• Failure to properly inspect and maintain your vehicle could result in a component malfunction and
effect vehicle handling and performance. This
could cause an accident.
8
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
CONTENTS
䡵 SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
䡵 WARRANTY INFORMATION . . . . . . . . .
YOUR VEHICLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
䡵 REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS . . . . . . . .
▫ Prepare For The Appointment. . . . . . . . . . . . .318
▫ In The 50 United States And Washington,
▫ Prepare A List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
D.C. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
▫ Be Reasonable With Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
▫ In Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . .321
. . . .321
. . . .321
. . . .322
䡵 IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318 䡵 PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS . . . . . . . . . . . .322
▫ Alfa Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319 䡵 DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
▫ Alfa Canada Customer Center . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
Impaired (TDD/TTY). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .319
▫ Treadwear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
▫ Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
▫ Temperature Grades. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
▫ Traction Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .324
9
318 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
SUGGESTIONS FOR OBTAINING SERVICE FOR
YOUR VEHICLE
Prepare For The Appointment
Be Reasonable With Requests
If you list a number of items and you must have your
vehicle by the end of the day, discuss the situation with
the service advisor and list the items in order of priority.
At many authorized dealers, you may obtain a rental
vehicle at a minimal daily charge. If you need a rental, it
is advisable to make these arrangements when you call
for an appointment.
If you are having warranty work done, be sure to have
the right papers with you. Take your warranty folder. All
work to be performed may not be covered by the
warranty. Discuss additional charges with the service
manager. Keep a maintenance log of your vehicle’s
service history. This can often provide a clue to the IF YOU NEED ASSISTANCE
current problem.
The manufacturer and its authorized dealer are vitally
Prepare A List
interested in your satisfaction. We want you to be happy
Make a written list of your vehicle’s problems or the with our products and services.
specific work you want done. If you’ve had an accident Warranty service must be done by an authorized dealer.
or work done that is not on your maintenance log, let the We strongly recommend that you take the vehicle to an
service advisor know.
authorized dealer. They know your vehicle the best, and
are most concerned that you get prompt and high quality
service. The manufacturer’s authorized dealer have the
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 319
facilities, factory-trained technicians, special tools, and • Authorized dealer name
the latest information to ensure the vehicle is fixed
• Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
correctly and in a timely manner.
• Vehicle delivery date and mileage
This is why you should always talk to an authorized
dealer service manager first. Most matters can be re- Alfa Customer Center
solved with this process.
P.O. Box 21–8004 Auburn Hills, MI 48321–8004 Phone:
• If for some reason you are still not satisfied, talk to the 1–844–Alfa–USA (1–844–253–2872)
general manager or owner of the authorized dealer. Alfa Canada Customer Center
They want to know if you need assistance.
P.O. Box 1621 Windsor, Ontario N9A 4H6 Phone: 1–800–
• If an authorized dealer is unable to resolve the con- 465–2001 (English) Phone: 1–800–387–9983 (French)
cern, you may contact the manufacturer’s customer
Customer Assistance For The Hearing Or Speech
center.
Impaired (TDD/TTY)
Any communication to the manufacturer’s customer cenTo assist customers who have hearing difficulties, the
ter should include the following information:
manufacturer has installed special TDD (Telecommuni• Owner’s name and address
cation Devices for the Deaf) equipment at its customer
• Owner’s telephone number (home and office)
center. Any hearing or speech impaired customer, who
has access to a TDD or a conventional teletypewriter
9
320 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
(TTY) in the United States, can communicate with the Hotline at 1-800-521-9922 (Canadian residents, call (800)
465–2001 English / (800) 387–9983 French).
manufacturer by dialing 1–800–380–CHRY.
The manufacturer will not stand behind any service
contract that is not the manufacturer’s service contract. It
is not responsible for any service contract other than the
manufacturer’s service contract. If you purchased a service contract that is not a manufacturer’s service contract,
and you require service after the manufacturer’s New
Service Contract
Vehicle Limited Warranty expires, please refer to the
You may have purchased a service contract for a vehicle contract documents, and contact the person listed in
to help protect you from the high cost of unexpected those documents.
repairs after the manufacturer’s New Vehicle Limited
We appreciate that you have made a major investment
Warranty expires. The manufacturer stands behind only
when you purchased the vehicle. An authorized dealer
the manufacturer’s service contracts. If you purchased a
has also made a major investment in facilities, tools, and
manufacturer’s service contract, you will receive Plan
training to assure that you are absolutely delighted with
Provisions and an Owner Identification Card in the mail
the ownership experience. You will be pleased with their
within three weeks of the vehicle delivery date. If you
sincere efforts to resolve any warranty issues or related
have any questions about the service contract, call the
concerns.
manufacturer’s Service Contract National Customer
Canadian residents with hearing difficulties that require
assistance can use the special needs relay service offered
by Bell Canada. For TTY teletypewriter users, dial 711
and for Voice callers, dial 1-800-855-0511 to connect with
a Bell Relay Service operator.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 321
WARNING!
Engine exhaust (internal combustion engines only),
some of its constituents, and certain vehicle components contain, or emit, chemicals known to the State
of California to cause cancer and birth defects, or
other reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids
contained in vehicles and certain products of component wear contain, or emit, chemicals known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth defects,
or other reproductive harm.
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
In The 50 United States And Washington, D.C.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect that could
cause a crash or cause injury or death, you should
immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying the
manufacturer.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an
investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in
a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy
campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
WARRANTY INFORMATION
individual problems between you, your authorized
See the Warranty Information Booklet, located on the dealer, and the manufacturer.
USB card, for the terms and provisions of ALFA ROMEO
Automobiles warranties applicable to this vehicle and
market.
9
322 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
To contact NHTSA, you may either call the Auto Safety
Hotline toll free at 1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–
424–9153), or go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:
Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
West Building, Washington, D.C. 20590. You can also
obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a safety defect, you
should contact the Customer Service Department immediately. Canadian customers who wish to report a safety
defect to the Canadian government should contact Transport Canada, Motor Vehicle Defect Investigations and
Recalls at 1-800-333-0510 or go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety/
PUBLICATION ORDER FORMS
To order the following manuals, you may use either the
website or the phone numbers listed below. Visa, Mastercard, American Express, and Discover orders are accepted. If you prefer mailing your payment, please call
for an order form.
NOTE: A street address is required when ordering
manuals (no P.O. Boxes).
Service Manuals
These comprehensive Service Manuals provide the information that students and professional technicians need in
diagnosing/troubleshooting, problem solving, maintaining, servicing, and repairing FIAT Group Automobiles
vehicles. A complete working knowledge of the vehicle,
system, and/or components is written in straightforward
language with illustrations, diagrams, and charts.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 323
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals
• Call toll free at:
Diagnostic Procedure Manuals are filled with diagrams,
charts and detailed illustrations. These practical manuals
make it easy for students and technicians to find and fix
problems on computer-controlled vehicle systems and
features. They show exactly how to find and correct
problems the first time, using step-by-step troubleshooting and drivability procedures, proven diagnostic tests
and a complete list of all tools and equipment.
1–800–890–4038 (U.S.)
Owner’s Manuals
These Owner’s Manuals have been prepared with the
assistance of service and engineering specialists to acquaint you with specific FIAT Group Automobiles vehicles. Included are starting, operating, emergency and
maintenance procedures as well as specifications, capabilities and safety tips.
1–800–387–1143 (Canada)
Or
• Visit us on the Worldwide Web at:
www.techauthority.com
DEPARTMENT OF TRANSPORTATION UNIFORM
TIRE QUALITY GRADES
The following tire grading categories were established by
the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration. The
specific grade rating assigned by the tire’s manufacturer
in each category is shown on the sidewall of the tires on
your vehicle.
All passenger car tires must conform to Federal safety
requirements in addition to these grades.
9
324 IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE
Treadwear
The Treadwear grade is a comparative rating, based on
the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled
conditions on a specified government test course. For
example, a tire graded 150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government course as a tire graded
100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the
actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart
significantly from the norm due to variations in driving
habits, service practices, and differences in road characteristics and climate.
Traction Grades
The Traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B,
and C. These grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on
wet pavement, as measured under controlled conditions
on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and
concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
WARNING!
The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not
include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
Temperature Grades
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat
and its ability to dissipate heat, when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the
material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure. The
grade C corresponds to a level of performance, which all
passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test
wheel, than the minimum required by law.
IF YOU NEED CONSUMER ASSISTANCE 325
WARNING!
The temperature grade for this tire is established for
a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, under-inflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause
heat buildup and possible tire failure.
9
INDEX
10
328 INDEX
Adding Engine Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Adding Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Adding Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41
Air Bag
Knee Impact Bolsters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .48
Air bag Deployment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .41, 48
Air bag Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52, 68
Air bag Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
Air Cleaner, Engine (Engine Air Cleaner Filter) . . . .252
Air Conditioner Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Air Conditioning Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255, 256
Air Conditioning System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
Air Pressure, Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Alarm System (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
Alfa DNA System (Dynamic Car Control System) . .163
Alfa Twin Clutch Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . .156, 248
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .276, 305
Alterations/Modifications, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant). . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266, 303
Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Automatic Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Automatic Transaxle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
Auto Unlock, Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Auxiliary Electrical Outlet (Power Outlet) . . . . . . . .100
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Keyless Transmitter Replacement (RKE) . . . . . . . .19
Belts, Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30, 33, 68
Body Mechanism Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
B-Pillar Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Brake Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
INDEX 329
Brake, Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Brake System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .174, 271
Anti-Lock (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Master Cylinder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Break-In Recommendations, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . .65
Bulb Replacement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289, 291
Bulbs, Light. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 289
Capacities, Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . .303
Capacities, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Caps, Filler
Oil (Engine) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Carbon Monoxide Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67, 217
Car Washes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Cellular Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Chart, Tire Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Checking Your Vehicle For Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Checks, Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55, 61
Clean Air Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Cleaning
Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Climate Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Clutch Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Contract, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303, 304
Cooling System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
Adding Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
Coolant Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266, 270
Disposal of Used Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Drain, Flush, and Refill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .266
10
330 INDEX
Child-Protection Door Lock — Rear Doors . . . . . .23
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Points to Remember . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269, 270
Pressure Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269 Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Selection of Coolant (Antifreeze) . . . . . . . . . . . . .266 Driving
Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow Standing
Corrosion Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Electrical Outlet, Auxiliary (Power Outlet) . . . . . . . .100
Daytime Running Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85 Electrical Power Outlets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .100
Dealer Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249 Electric Remote Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Deck Lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .27 Electronic Brake Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .175
Deck Lid, Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80 Electronic Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . . .92
Defroster, Windshield . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68 Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Delay (Intermittent) Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Activation Trip Data (Trip B On) . . . . . . . . . . . .129
Autoclose . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
Diagnostic System, Onboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Average Fuel Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Dimmer Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Average Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
Disposal
Buzzer Volume (Adjusting The Failure/Warning
Antifreeze (Engine Coolant) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .269
Buzzer Volume) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
INDEX 331
Change Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Change Engine Oil Indicator System . . . . . .
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . .
Distance Traveled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Electronic Vehicle Information Center (EVIC)
Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exit Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Exit Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Fuel Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Indications On Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Instant Fuel Consumption . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Language (Selecting The Language) . . . . . .
New Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Oil Life . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Service (Scheduled Servicing) . . . . . . . . . . .
Set Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Speed Beep (Speed Limit) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Start Of Trip Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Time Adjustment (Clock) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130
. . . .137
Travel Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
. . . .137
Trip Button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
. . . .136
Trip Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
. . . .141
Trip Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138
. . . .125
Units (Set Units) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133
Setup
Values Displayed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140
. . . .127
. . . .137 Emergency, In Case of
Freeing Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
. . . .139
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
. . . .141
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
. . . .140
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
. . . .141
. . . .134 Engine
. . . .139
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Break-In Recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
. . . .137
Checking Oil Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
. . . .135
Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247
. . . .131
Cooling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .265
. . . .128
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67, 217
. . . .139
10
332 INDEX
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Engine Oil Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Flashers
Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Flooded Engine Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Fluid, Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
Fluid Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Fluid Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Fluids, Lubricants and Genuine Parts . . . . . . . . . . .304
Four-Way Hazard Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Freeing A Stuck Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Adding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .218
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Filters
Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Materials Added . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .216
Engine Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304
Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Flooded, Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
Fuel Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250, 303
Oil Filler Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Oil Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Enhanced Accident Response Feature. . . . . . . . .50, 238
Euro Twin Clutch Transmission
Fluid Type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Exhaust Gas Caution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67, 217
Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67, 263
Exterior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
INDEX 333
.214
.214
.303
.218
.284
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Heated Mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Heater. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143, 145
Holder, Cup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
Gasoline, Clean Air . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Gasoline (Fuel). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214, 303
Gasoline, Reformulated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142, 214
General Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Glass Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Ignition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Ignition Key Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Immobilizer (Sentry Key) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Infant Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55, 58
Inside Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111
Instrument Panel and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110
Instrument Panel Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .282
Instrument Panel Lens Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Interior Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
Octane Rating .
Requirements .
Tank Capacity .
Fueling . . . . . . .
Fuses . . . . . . . . .
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
Hazard
Driving Through Flowing, Rising, or Shallow
Standing Water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .281
10
334 INDEX
Interior Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87 Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Intermittent Wipers (Delay Wipers) . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 Light Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 289
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 83, 84
Airbag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .52, 68
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .232
Exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Hazard Warning Flasher . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Key Fob
Illuminated Entry . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Lock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Instrument Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
Key-In Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Key, Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .291
Key, Sentry (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Tire Pressure Monitoring (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Turn Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Lane Change Assist . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .86
Warning (Instrument Cluster Description) . . . . . .112
Lap/Shoulder Belts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Latches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 Loading Vehicle
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190
Lead Free Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Leaks, Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69 Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
INDEX 335
Auto Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .23
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Lubrication, Body . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Lug Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .225
Modifications/Alterations, Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Monitor, Tire Pressure System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Multi-Function Control Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .84
Maintenance Free Battery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .254
Maintenance, General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Maintenance Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .249
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
Manual, Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Manual Transmission
Lubricant Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .305
Master Cylinder (Brakes) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Electric Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Heated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .76
Outside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .74
Occupant Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30, 48
Octane Rating, Gasoline (Fuel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Oil, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250, 303, 304
Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .303
Change Interval . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .250
Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Filter Disposal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Materials Added to . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
Recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251, 303
Viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .251
Oil Filter, Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .252
New Vehicle Break-In Period . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
10
336 INDEX
Onboard Diagnostic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Operating Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Operator Manual (Owner’s Manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Outside Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Overheating, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Owner’s Manual (Operator Manual) . . . . . . . . . .5, 322
Paint Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .277
Parking Brake. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .172
Passing Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .85
Pets. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Pets, Transporting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Placard, Tire and Loading Information . . . . . . . . . .191
Power
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Pregnant Women and Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Pretensioners
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Radial Ply Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Radio Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .142
Reclining Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Recreational Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Reformulated Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .215
Refrigerant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Reminder, Seat Belt. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .21
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .17
Unlock The Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .18
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Replacement Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Replacement Parts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .248
Replacement Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Restraint, Head . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
INDEX 337
Restraints, Child . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55
Restraints, Infant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .58
Restraints, Occupant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30
Rocking Vehicle When Stuck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Rotation, Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Safety Checks Inside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Safety Checks Outside Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Safety Defects, Reporting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .321
Safety, Exhaust Gas. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .67
Safety Information, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Safety Tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Schedule, Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
Seat Belt
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) . . . . . . . . . . .39
Seat Belt Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
Seat Belt Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .32
Seat Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30, 31, 33, 68
Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .55, 58, 61
Front Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .31
Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Operating Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
Pregnant Women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Pretensioners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .38
Untwisting Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77
Reclining . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
Security Alarm . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .15
SENTRY KEY®
FCC General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .14
Sentry Key (Immobilizer) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .13
Service Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .318
Service Contract . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Service Manuals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .322
Shoulder Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
Signals, Turn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69
Snow Chains (Tire Chains) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
10
338 INDEX
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200 Tire and Loading Information Placard . . . . . . .190, 191
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202, 203 Tire Markings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
Spark Plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .304 Tires. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .69, 195, 323
Aging (Life of Tires) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Speed Control (Cruise Control) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92
Air Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .207
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .202
Cold Weather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
Engine Fails to Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .155
High Speed . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Steering
Inflation Pressures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Column Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Life of Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
Tilt Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Load Capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .190, 191
Wheel, Tilt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . .209
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Storage, Vehicle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Pressure Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112
Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
Storing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Radial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .198
Stuck, Freeing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .236
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .208
Telescoping Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183, 195
Tilt Steering Column . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91
INDEX 339
Sizes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .185
Snow Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .200
Spinning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Tire Safety Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .183
To Open Deck Lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Recreational . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Towing Eyes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .240
Towing Vehicle Behind a Motorhome . . . . . . . . . . .221
Traction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .169
Trailer Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .221
Transaxle
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11
Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .157
Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .156
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .275
Transmitter Battery Service (Remote Keyless Entry) . .19
Transporting Passengers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .66
Transporting Pets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .65
Tread Wear Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .204
Uniform Tire Quality Grades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
Unleaded Gasoline . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .214
Untwisting Procedure, Seat Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Vehicle Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .191
Vehicle Modifications/Alterations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8
Vehicle Security Alarm (Security Alarm) . . . . . . . . . .15
Vehicle Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Ventilation System. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143
Warning Flasher, Hazard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .224
Warning Lights (Instrument Cluster Description) . . .112
Warnings and Cautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7
Warranty Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4, 321
10
340 INDEX
Washer
Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .260
Washers, Windshield. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Washing Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .278
Water
Driving Through . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .170
Wheel and Wheel Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Wheel and Wheel Trim Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .279
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .25
Windshield Defroster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .68
Windshield Washers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Windshield Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .257
Wipers, Intermittent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89
INSTALLATION OF RADIO TRANSMITTING
EQUIPMENT
Special design considerations are incorporated into this
vehicle’s electronic system to provide immunity to radio
frequency signals. Mobile two-way radios and telephone
equipment must be installed properly by trained personnel. The following must be observed during installation.
The positive power connection should be made directly
to the battery and fused as close to the battery as possible.
The negative power connection should be made to body
sheet metal adjacent to the negative battery connection.
This connection should not be fused.
Antennas for two-way radios should be mounted on the
roof or the rear area of the vehicle. Care should be used
in mounting antennas with magnet bases. Magnets may
affect the accuracy or operation of the compass on
vehicles so equipped.
The antenna cable should be as short as practical and
routed away from the vehicle wiring when possible. Use
only fully shielded coaxial cable.
Carefully match the antenna and cable to the radio to
ensure a low Standing Wave Ratio (SWR).
Mobile radio equipment with output power greater than
normal may require special precautions.
All installations should be checked for possible interference between the communications equipment and the
vehicle’s electronic systems.
2015 4C
2015
OWNER’S MANUAL
Chrysler Group LLC
154C-126-AC
154C-126-AB
Third
Edition
Rev. 1
Second
Edition
PrintedininU.S.A.
U.S.A.
Printed
4C